flash/nor/tcl: Make write_bank parameter optional
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{imx_gpio}
599 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
600
601 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
602 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
603 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
604
605 @end itemize
606
607 @node About Jim-Tcl
608 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex Jim-Tcl
610 @cindex tcl
611
612 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
613 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
614 command interpreter.
615
616 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
617 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
618 much of anything about Tcl.
619 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
620
621 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
622 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
623 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
624 OpenOCD mailing list.
625
626 @itemize @bullet
627 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
628 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
629 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
630 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
631 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
632 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
633
634 @item @b{Missing Features}
635 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
636 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
637 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
638 enabled in OpenOCD.
639
640 @item @b{Scripts}
641 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
642 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
643 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
644
645 @item @b{Commands}
646 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
647 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
648 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
649 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
650
651 @item @b{Historical Note}
652 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
653 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
654 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
655 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
656
657 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
658 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
659 @end itemize
660
661 @node Running
662 @chapter Running
663 @cindex command line options
664 @cindex logfile
665 @cindex directory search
666
667 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
668 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
669 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
670 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
671 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
672 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
673 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
674
675 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
676 tell it how each debug session should work.
677 The @option{--help} option shows:
678 @verbatim
679 bash$ openocd --help
680
681 --help | -h display this help
682 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
683 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
684 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
685 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
686 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
687 --command | -c run <command>
688 @end verbatim
689
690 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
691 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
692 To specify one or more different
693 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
694
695 @example
696 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
697 @end example
698
699 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
700 @enumerate
701 @item the current directory,
702 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
703 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
704 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
705 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
706 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
707 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
708 @end enumerate
709 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
710
711 @quotation Note
712 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
713 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
714 @end quotation
715
716 @section Simple setup, no customization
717
718 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
719 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
720 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
721 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
722 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
723
724 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
725 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
726 the server with some variation of one of the following:
727
728 @example
729 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
730 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
731 @end example
732
733 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
734 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
735 If all goes well you'll see output something like
736
737 @example
738 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
739 For bug reports, read
740 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
741 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
742 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
743 @end example
744
745 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
746 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
747 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
748
749 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
750
751 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
752 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
753 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
754 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
755 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
756 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
757 ensure that this always succeeds.
758 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
759 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
760 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
761 and then shut down without acting as a server.
762
763 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
764 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
765 those channels.
766
767 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
768 the @option{-d} option.
769
770 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
771 @option{-c} command line switch.
772
773 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
774 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
775 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
776 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
777 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
778 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
779 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
780
781 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
782 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
783
784 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
785 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
786 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
787 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
788
789 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
790 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
791
792 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
793 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
794 and start the OpenOCD server.
795 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
796 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
797 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
798 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
799
800 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
801
802 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
803 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
804 and a USB cable on the other.
805 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
806 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
807
808 @enumerate
809 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
810 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
811 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
812 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
813 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
814 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
815 debugging host.
816
817 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
818 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
819 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
820 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
821 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
822
823 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
824 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
825 with 1.2 Volt boards.
826
827 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
828 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
829 ways to connect the cable.
830 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
831 Be sure it's firmly connected.
832
833 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
834 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
835 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
836 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
837 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
838 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
839 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
840 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
841
842 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
843 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
844 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
845 but are tedious to set up.
846 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
847 adapter signals to the right board pins.
848
849 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
850 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
851 you are using to run OpenOCD.
852 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
853
854 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
855 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
856 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
857 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
858
859 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
860 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
861 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
862
863 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
864 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
865 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
866 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
867
868 @end enumerate
869
870 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
871 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
872 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
873
874 @section Project Directory
875
876 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
877
878 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
879 single directory for your work with a given board.
880 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
881 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
882 files accessed through semihosting,
883 and for code you upload to the target board.
884 It is also the natural place to write files,
885 such as log files and data you download from the board.
886
887 @section Configuration Basics
888
889 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
890 a variety of ways you can mix them.
891 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
892
893 @itemize
894 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
895 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
896 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
897 @end itemize
898
899 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
900 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
901 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
902
903 @example
904 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
905
906 # GDB can also flash my flash!
907 gdb_memory_map enable
908 gdb_flash_program enable
909
910 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
911 @end example
912
913 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
914
915 @example
916 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
917 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
918 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
919 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
920 @end example
921
922 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
923 each supporting a different development task.
924 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
925 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
926
927 @quotation Important
928 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
929 problems with how it treats variables.
930 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
931 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
932 that can be tested in a later script.
933 @end quotation
934
935 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
936 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
937 to simplify your work.
938
939 @section User Config Files
940 @cindex config file, user
941 @cindex user config file
942 @cindex config file, overview
943
944 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
945 in one place.
946 One of the following will match your situation best:
947
948 @itemize
949 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
950 provided by someone else.
951 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
952 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
953 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
954 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
955 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
956 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
957
958 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
959 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
960
961 @enumerate
962 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
963 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
964 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
965 @end enumerate
966
967 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
968 The first is an interface config file.
969 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
970 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
971 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
972 meet your deadline:
973
974 @example
975 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
976 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
977 @end example
978
979 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
980 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
981 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
982 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
983
984 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
985 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
986 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
987 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
988 target and board
989 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
990 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
991
992 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
993 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
994 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
995 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
996
997 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
998 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
999 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1000 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1001 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1002
1003 @quotation Note
1004 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1005 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1006 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1007 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1008 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1009 @end quotation
1010
1011 @item
1012 You may may need to write some C code.
1013 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1014 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1015 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1016 a new chip architecture.
1017 @end itemize
1018
1019 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1020 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1021 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1022
1023 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1024 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1025 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1026 @itemize
1027
1028 @item
1029 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1030 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1031 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1032 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1033
1034 @item
1035 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1036 @cindex vector_catch
1037 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1038 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1039 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1040 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1041 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1042 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1043
1044 @item
1045 You might need to override some defaults.
1046 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1047 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1048
1049 @item
1050 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1051 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1052 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1053 @end itemize
1054
1055 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1056
1057 A few project-specific utility
1058 routines may well speed up your work.
1059 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1060
1061 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1062 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1063 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1064 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1065 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1066 may help:
1067
1068 @example
1069 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1070 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1071 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1072 # Leave the CPU halted.
1073 reset init
1074
1075 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1076 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1077
1078 # Start running.
1079 resume 0x20000000
1080 @}
1081 @end example
1082
1083 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1084 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1085 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1086 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1087 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1088
1089 @example
1090 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1091 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1092 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1093 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1094 reset init
1095
1096 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1097 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1098 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1100 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1101 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1102 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1103
1104 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1105 reset run
1106 @}
1107 @end example
1108
1109 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1110 from NAND.
1111 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1112 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1113 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1114
1115 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1116 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1117
1118 @section Target Software Changes
1119
1120 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1121 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1122 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1123 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1124 handling issues like:
1125
1126 @itemize @bullet
1127
1128 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1129 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1130 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1131 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1132 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1133 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1134 your debug sessions.
1135
1136 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1137 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1138 That might however be your only option.
1139
1140 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1141 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1142 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1143 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1144 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1145 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1146 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1147 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1148 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1149 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1150 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1151 instead of the whole thing.
1152 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1153 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1154
1155 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1156 @cindex ARM semihosting
1157 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1158 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1159 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1160 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1161 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1162 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1163 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1164 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1165 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1166 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1167 NAND or SPI flash.
1168
1169 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1170 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1171 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1172 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1173 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1174
1175 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1176 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1177 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1178 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1179 registers which can be used to change various features including
1180 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1181 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1182 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1183 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1184 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1185
1186 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1187 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1188 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1189 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1190 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1191
1192 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1193 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1194 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1195 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1196 early code execution can be debugged
1197 or firmware can be replaced.
1198
1199 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1200 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1201 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1202 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1203 operations like writing to memory.)
1204
1205 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1206 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1207 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1208 various kinds of message.
1209 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1210
1211 @end itemize
1212
1213 @section Target Hardware Setup
1214
1215 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1216 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1217 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1218 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1219 working with.}
1220
1221 Common issues include:
1222
1223 @itemize @bullet
1224
1225 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1226 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1227 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1228 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1229 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1230 or one from a daughtercard).
1231 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1232 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1233
1234 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1235 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1236 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1237 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1238 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1239 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1240
1241 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1242 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1243 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1244 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1245 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1246
1247
1248 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1249 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1250 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1251 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1252 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1253 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1254 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1255
1256 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1257 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1258 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1259 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1260 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1261
1262 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1263 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1264 used to start booting.
1265
1266 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1267 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1268 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1269 multiple audio codec chips).
1270 This interacts with software
1271 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1272 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1273 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1274 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1275 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1276 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1277 audio or video codecs are used.
1278
1279 @end itemize
1280
1281 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1282 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1283 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1284 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1285 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1286 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1287 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1288 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1289 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1290 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1291
1292
1293 @node Config File Guidelines
1294 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1295
1296 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1297 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1298 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1299 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1300
1301 You should find the following directories under
1302 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1303 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1304 @itemize @bullet
1305 @item @file{interface} ...
1306 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1307 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1308 @item @file{board} ...
1309 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1310 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1311
1312 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1313 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1314 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1315 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1316 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1317 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1318 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1319 a CPU and an FPGA.
1320 @item @file{target} ...
1321 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1322 on a chip
1323 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1324 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1325 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1326 the target config file defines all of them.
1327 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1328 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1329 @end itemize
1330
1331 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1332 file may override features in any of the above files by
1333 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1334 commands specific to their situation.
1335
1336 @section Interface Config Files
1337
1338 The user config file
1339 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1340
1341 @example
1342 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1343 @end example
1344
1345 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1346 in use today with OpenOCD.
1347 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1348 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1349
1350 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1351 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1352 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1353 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1354 and need to provide a driver for it.
1355
1356 @section Board Config Files
1357 @cindex config file, board
1358 @cindex board config file
1359
1360 The user config file
1361 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1362
1363 @example
1364 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1365 @end example
1366
1367 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1368 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1369 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1370
1371 @enumerate
1372 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1373 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1374 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1375 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1376 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1377 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1378 @end enumerate
1379
1380 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1381 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1382 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1383 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1384
1385 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1386 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1387 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1388 configuration works.
1389
1390 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1391
1392 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1393 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1394 convention on how to use certain variables.
1395
1396 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1397 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1398 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1399 used at will within a target configuration file.
1400
1401 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1402 for a board with three chips:
1403
1404 @example
1405 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1406 set CHIPNAME network
1407 set ENDIAN big
1408 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1409 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1410 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1411 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1412
1413 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1414 set CHIPNAME video
1415 set ENDIAN little
1416 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1417 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1418 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1419 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1420
1421 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1422 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1423 unset ENDIAN
1424 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1425 @end example
1426
1427 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1428 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1429 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1430 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1431 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1432 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1433 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1434 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1435
1436 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1437 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1438 naming collisions.
1439
1440 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1441 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1442 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1443 up other clocks and peripherals.
1444
1445 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1446 @cindex variable names
1447
1448 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1449 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1450 one such chip (as shown above).
1451 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1452 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1453 to promote consistency and
1454 so that board files can override target defaults.
1455
1456 Inputs to target config files include:
1457
1458 @itemize @bullet
1459 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1460 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1461 tap identifier dotted names.
1462 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1463 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1464 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1465 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1466 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1467 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1468 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1469 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1470 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1471 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1472 @end itemize
1473
1474 Outputs from target config files include:
1475
1476 @itemize @bullet
1477 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1478 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1479 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1480 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1481 specific to that board and that target.
1482 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1483 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1484 @end itemize
1485
1486 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1487 @cindex event, reset-init
1488 @cindex reset-init handler
1489
1490 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1491 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1492 fully set up yet.
1493 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1494 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1495 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1496 handler is one of the most important.
1497
1498 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1499 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1500 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1501 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1502 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1503
1504 @quotation Note
1505 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1506 are included here.
1507 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1508 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1509 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1510 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1511 @end quotation
1512
1513 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1514 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1515 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1516 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1517 those as parameters.
1518 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1519 and disabling the watchdog.
1520 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1521 the next developer doing such work.
1522 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1523
1524 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1525 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1526 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1527 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1528
1529 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1530
1531 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1532 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1533 a low JTAG clock rate.
1534 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1535 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1536 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1537 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1538 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1539 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1540 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1541
1542 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1543 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1544 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1545 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1546 which might be less than that.
1547
1548 @quotation Warning
1549 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1550 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1551 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1552 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1553 @end quotation
1554
1555 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1556 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1557 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1558 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1559 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1560 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1561
1562 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1563 @subsection The init_board procedure
1564 @cindex init_board procedure
1565
1566 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1567 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1568 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1569 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1570 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1571 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1572 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1573 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1574 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1575 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1576 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1577 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1578
1579 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1580 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1581
1582 @example
1583 ### board_file.cfg ###
1584
1585 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1586 source [find target/target.cfg]
1587
1588 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1589 # enables fast on-board clock source
1590 # configures the chip to use it
1591 @}
1592
1593 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1594 proc init_board @{@} @{
1595 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1596
1597 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1598 adapter_khz 1
1599 enable_fast_clock
1600 adapter_khz 10000
1601 @}
1602 @}
1603 @end example
1604
1605 @section Target Config Files
1606 @cindex config file, target
1607 @cindex target config file
1608
1609 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1610 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1611 more target config files like this:
1612
1613 @example
1614 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1615 @end example
1616
1617 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1618 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1619 In summary the target files should contain
1620
1621 @enumerate
1622 @item Set defaults
1623 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1624 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1625 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1626 @item On-Chip flash
1627 @end enumerate
1628
1629 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1630 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1631 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1632
1633 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1634 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1635 can talk to the chip.
1636 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1637 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1638 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1639 and other processing engines.
1640
1641 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1642
1643 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1644 letting board config files express environment-specific
1645 differences in how things should be set up.
1646
1647 @example
1648 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1649 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1650 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1651 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1652 @} else @{
1653 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1654 @}
1655
1656 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1657 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1658 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1659 @} else @{
1660 set _ENDIAN little
1661 @}
1662
1663 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1664 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1665 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1666 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1667 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1670 @}
1671 @end example
1672 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1673
1674 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1675 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1676 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1677
1678 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1679 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1680 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1681
1682 @example
1683 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1684 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1685 @end example
1686
1687 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1688 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1689 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1690 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1691 for taps.
1692
1693 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1694 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1695 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1696 looks (in part) like this:
1697
1698 @example
1699 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1700 @end example
1701
1702 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1703 to source such a config file twice, with different
1704 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1705 it adds a different TAP each time.
1706
1707 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1708 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1709 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1710 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1711
1712 @example
1713 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1714 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1715 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1716 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1717 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1718 @end example
1719
1720 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1721 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1722
1723 @itemize
1724 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1725 plus a JRC to enable them
1726 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1727 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1728 is not currently used)
1729 @end itemize
1730
1731 @subsection Add CPU targets
1732
1733 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1734 GDB and other commands can use it.
1735 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1736 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1737 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1738 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1739
1740 @example
1741 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1742 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1743 @end example
1744
1745 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1746 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1747 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1748 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1749 a work area if you can.
1750 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1751
1752 @example
1753 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1754 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1755 @end example
1756
1757 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1758 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1759 @cindex SMP
1760 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1761
1762 @example
1763 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1764 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1765 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1766 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1767 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1768 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1769 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1770 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1771 @end example
1772 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1773 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1774 @itemize @bullet
1775 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1776 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1777 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1778 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1779 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1780 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1781 @end itemize
1782
1783 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1784 command have been implemented.
1785 @itemize @bullet
1786 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1788 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1789 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1790 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1791 following example.
1792 @end itemize
1793
1794 @example
1795 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1796 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1797 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1798 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1799 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1800 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1801 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1802 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1803 > resume
1804 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1805 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1806 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1807 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1808 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1809 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1810 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1811 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1812 @end example
1813
1814
1815 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1816
1817 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1818 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1819 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1820
1821 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1822 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1823 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1824 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1825 both signals.
1826
1827 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1828 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1829 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1830 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1831 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1832 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1833 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1834 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1835 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1836 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1837 not available.)
1838
1839 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1840 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1841 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1842 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1843 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1844 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1845 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1846 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1847
1848 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1849 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1850 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1851 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1852 slower clock than they will use later.
1853 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1854 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1855 than they will use later.
1856 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1857
1858 @quotation Important
1859 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1860 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1861 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1862 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1863 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1864 @end quotation
1865
1866 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1867 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1868 @cindex init_targets procedure
1869
1870 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1871 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1872 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1873 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1874 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1875 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1876 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1877 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1878 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1879
1880 @example
1881 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1882
1883 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1884 # basic initialization procedure ...
1885 @}
1886
1887 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1888 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1889 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1890 @}
1891
1892 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1893
1894 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1895
1896 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1897 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1898 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1899 @}
1900 @end example
1901
1902 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1903 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1904
1905 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1906
1907 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1908 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1909
1910 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1911 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1912 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1913
1914 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1915 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1916 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1917 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1918 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1919 events already assigned.
1920
1921 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1922
1923 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1924 special high speed download features - enable it.
1925
1926 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1927
1928 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1929 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1930 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1931 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1932 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1933 If you are using an external trace port,
1934 configure it in your board config file.
1935 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1936 configure it in your target config file.
1937
1938 @example
1939 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1940 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1941 @end example
1942
1943 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1944
1945 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1946
1947 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1948 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1949 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1950 the TARGET (chip) file.
1951
1952 Examples:
1953 @itemize @bullet
1954 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1955 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1956 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1957 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1958 @end itemize
1959
1960 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1961 @section Translating Configuration Files
1962 @cindex translation
1963 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1964 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1965 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1966 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1967 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1968 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1969
1970 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1971 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1972 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1973 convert other scripts later on.
1974
1975 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1976 replace job:
1977
1978 @example
1979 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1980 #
1981 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1982 #
1983 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1984 #
1985 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1986
1987 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1988 global TARGETNAME
1989
1990 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1991
1992 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1993 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1994 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1995 @}
1996 @end example
1997
1998
1999
2000 @node Server Configuration
2001 @chapter Server Configuration
2002 @cindex initialization
2003 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2004 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2005 supported.
2006
2007 @anchor{configurationstage}
2008 @section Configuration Stage
2009 @cindex configuration stage
2010 @cindex config command
2011
2012 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2013 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2014 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2015 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2016 inside startup scripts.
2017
2018 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2019 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2020 which may be issued interactively.
2021 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2022 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2023
2024 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2025 flash banks,
2026 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2027 and other basic setup.
2028 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2029 may access or activate TAPs.
2030 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2031 longer be issued.
2032
2033 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2034 @section Entering the Run Stage
2035
2036 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2037 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2038 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2039 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2040 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2041 You should see no errors at this point.
2042 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2043 commands you used to configure the server.
2044 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2045 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2046 on the scan chain.
2047
2048 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2049 become available.
2050 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2051 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2052 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2053 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2054 entry to the run stage.
2055
2056 @deffn {Config Command} init
2057 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2058 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2059 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2060 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2061 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2062 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2063
2064 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2065 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2066 configuration files and/or command line options.
2067
2068 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2069 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2070 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2071 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2072 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2073 @end deffn
2074
2075 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2076 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2077 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2078
2079 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2080 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2081 scan chain.
2082 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2083 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2084
2085 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2086 they return.
2087 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2088 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2089 @end deffn
2090
2091 @anchor{tcpipports}
2092 @section TCP/IP Ports
2093 @cindex TCP port
2094 @cindex server
2095 @cindex port
2096 @cindex security
2097 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2098 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2099 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2100
2101 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2102 access using one or more of these ports.
2103 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2104 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2105 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2106
2107 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2108 @cindex GDB server
2109 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2110 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2111 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2112 the normal use cases.
2113
2114 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2115 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2116 disables the gdb server.
2117
2118 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2119 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2120
2121 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2122 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2123
2124 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2125 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2126 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2127
2128 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2129 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2130 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2131 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2132
2133 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2134 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2135 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2136
2137 @end deffn
2138
2139 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2140 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2141 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2142 output from the Tcl engine.
2143 Intended as a machine interface.
2144 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2145 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2146 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2147 @end deffn
2148
2149 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2150 Specify or query the
2151 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2152 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2153 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2154 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2155 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2156 @end deffn
2157
2158 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2159 @section GDB Configuration
2160 @cindex GDB
2161 @cindex GDB configuration
2162 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2163 The ones listed here are static and global.
2164 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2165 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2166
2167 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2168 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2169 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2170 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2171 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2172 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2173 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2174 @end deffn
2175
2176 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2177 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2178 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2179 vFlash packet is received.
2180 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2181 @end deffn
2182
2183 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2184 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2185 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2186 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2187 for flash programming to work.
2188 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2189 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2193 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2194 by GDB memory read packets.
2195 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2196 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2197 @end deffn
2198
2199 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2200 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2201 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2205 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2206
2207 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @anchor{eventpolling}
2211 @section Event Polling
2212
2213 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2214 where significant events can happen at any time.
2215 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2216 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2217 or to GDB.
2218
2219 Examples of such events include:
2220
2221 @itemize
2222 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2223 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2224 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2225 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2226 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2227 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2228 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2229 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2230 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2231 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2232 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2233 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2234 @end itemize
2235
2236 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2237 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2238 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2239 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2240 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2241
2242 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2243 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2244 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2245 to the various active targets.
2246 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2247 which is normally done in the background.
2248
2249 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2250 Poll the current target for its current state.
2251 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2252 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2253 specific information about the current state is printed.
2254 An optional parameter
2255 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2256
2257 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2258 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2259 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2260 @example
2261 > poll
2262 background polling: on
2263 target state: halted
2264 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2265 current mode: Supervisor
2266 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2267 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2268 >
2269 @end example
2270 @end deffn
2271
2272 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2273 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2274 @cindex config file, interface
2275 @cindex interface config file
2276
2277 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2278 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2279 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2280
2281 @quotation Note
2282 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2283 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2284 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2285 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2286 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2287 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2288 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2289 @end quotation
2290
2291 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2292 through commands in an interface configuration
2293 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2294 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2295
2296 @example
2297 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2298 @end example
2299
2300 These commands tell
2301 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2302 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2303
2304 @example
2305 # jlink interface
2306 interface jlink
2307 @end example
2308
2309 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2310
2311
2312 @section Interface Configuration
2313
2314 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2315 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2316 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2317
2318 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2319 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2320 target.
2321 @end deffn
2322
2323 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2324 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2325 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2326 @end deffn
2327 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2328 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2329 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2330 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2331 the hardware can support.
2332 @end deffn
2333
2334
2335
2336 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2337 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2338 @end deffn
2339
2340 @section Interface Drivers
2341
2342 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2343 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2344 available at run time.
2345
2346 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2347 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2348 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2349 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2350
2351 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2352 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2353 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2354 @end deffn
2355
2356 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2357 Displays status of RTCK option.
2358 Optionally sets that option first.
2359 @end deffn
2360 @end deffn
2361
2362 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2363 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2364 This has one driver-specific command:
2365
2366 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2367 Logs some status
2368 @end deffn
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2372 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2373 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2374 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2375 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2376 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2380 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2381
2382 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2383 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2384 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2385 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2386 @example
2387 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2388 @end example
2389 @end deffn
2390
2391 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2392 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2393 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2397 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2402 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2403 @end deffn
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2406 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2410 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2411 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2412
2413 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2414 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2415
2416 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added competely through
2417 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2418
2419 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2420 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2421 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2422 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2423 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2424 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2425
2426 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2427 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2428 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2429 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2430 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2431
2432 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2433 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2434 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2435 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2436
2437 @itemize @minus
2438 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2439 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2440 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2441 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2442 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2443 switching data and direction as necessary
2444 @end itemize
2445
2446 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2447 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2448
2449 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2450 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2451 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2452 @example
2453 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2454 @end example
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2458 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2459 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2460 during device selection.
2461 @end deffn
2462
2463 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2464 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2465 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2466 is connected to the host.
2467 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2468 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2469 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2470 @end deffn
2471
2472 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2473 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2474 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2475 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2476 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2477 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2478
2479 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2483 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2484 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2485 @end deffn
2486
2487 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2488 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2489 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2490 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2491 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2492 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2493 and initially asserted reset signals.
2494 @end deffn
2495
2496 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2497 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2498 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2499 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2500 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2501 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2502 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2503 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2504 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2505 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2506 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2507
2508 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2509 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2510 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2511 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2512 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2513 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2514
2515 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2516 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2517 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2518 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2519 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2520 are always driven by the FTDI.
2521
2522 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2523 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2524 @var{name}.
2525 @end deffn
2526
2527 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2528 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2529 @itemize @minus
2530 @item @option{0}, drive low
2531 @item @option{1}, drive high
2532 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2533 @end itemize
2534 @end deffn
2535
2536 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2537 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2538 @end deffn
2539
2540 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2541 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2542
2543 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2544 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2545 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2546 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2547 @itemize @minus
2548 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2549 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2550 @end itemize
2551 @end deffn
2552
2553 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2554 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2555
2556 @end deffn
2557
2558 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2559 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2560 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2561 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2562
2563 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2564 processors which are being simulated.
2565
2566 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2567 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2568 sockets instead of TCP.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2572 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2573 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2577 something like:
2578
2579 @example
2580 interface remote_bitbang
2581 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2582 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2583 @end example
2584
2585 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2586 named mysocket:
2587
2588 @example
2589 interface remote_bitbang
2590 remote_bitbang_port 0
2591 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2592 @end example
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2596 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2597 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2598 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2599
2600 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2601 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2602 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2603 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2604 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2605 @end deffn
2606
2607 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2608 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2609 default values are used.
2610 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2611 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2612 @example
2613 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2614 @end example
2615 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2616 @example
2617 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2618 @end example
2619 @end deffn
2620
2621 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2622 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2623 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2624 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2625 target board.
2626
2627 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2628 @example
2629 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2630 reset_config srst_only
2631 @end example
2632 @end deffn
2633
2634 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2635 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2636 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2637 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2641 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2642 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2643 @end deffn
2644
2645 @end deffn
2646
2647 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2648 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2649 This has one driver-specific command:
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2652 Display either the address of the I/O port
2653 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2654 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2655 This is a write-once setting.
2656 @end deffn
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2660 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2661 transports.
2662
2663 @quotation Compatibility Note
2664 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2665 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2666 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2667 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2668 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2669 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2670 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2671 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2672 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2673 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2674 @end quotation
2675
2676 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2677 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2678 states.
2679 @end deffn
2680 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2681 Display free device internal memory.
2682 @end deffn
2683 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2684 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2685 command version.
2686 @end deffn
2687 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2688 Display the device configuration.
2689 @end deffn
2690 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2691 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2692 power state.
2693 @end deffn
2694 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2695 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2696 @end deffn
2697 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2698 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2699 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2700 IP configuration.
2701 @end deffn
2702 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2703 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2704 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2705 @end deffn
2706 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2707 Reset the current configuration.
2708 @end deffn
2709 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2710 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2711 @end deffn
2712 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2713 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2714 pairs.
2715
2716 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2717 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2718 @example
2719 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2720 @end example
2721 @end deffn
2722 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2723 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2724 pairs.
2725
2726 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2727 @example
2728 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2729 77a90000
2730 @end example
2731 @end deffn
2732 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2733 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2734 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2735 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2736 instead.
2737
2738 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2739 @end deffn
2740 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2741 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2742 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2743
2744 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2745 @end deffn
2746 @end deffn
2747
2748 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2749 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2750 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2751 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2752 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2753 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2754 configuration script.
2755
2756 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2757 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2758 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2759 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2760 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2761
2762 Known limitations:
2763 @itemize @bullet
2764 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2765 and 2.7 MHz.
2766 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2767 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2768 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2769 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2770 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2771 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2772 communications with the target.
2773 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2774 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2775 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2776 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2777 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2778 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2779 @end itemize
2780
2781 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2782 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2783 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2787 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2788 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2789 @end deffn
2790
2791 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2792 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2793 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2794 target as a side-effect.
2795 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2799 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2800 version, and target voltage.
2801 @end deffn
2802 @end deffn
2803
2804 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2805 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2806 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2807 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2808 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2809
2810 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2811 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2812 This is a write-once setting.
2813 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2814
2815 @itemize @minus
2816 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2817 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2818 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2819 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2820 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2821 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2822 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2823 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2824 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2825 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2826 some versions of
2827 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2828 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2829 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2830 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2831 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2832 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2833 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2834 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2835 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2836 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2837 @end itemize
2838 @end deffn
2839
2840 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2841 Display either the address of the I/O port
2842 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2843 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2844 This is a write-once setting.
2845
2846 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2847 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2848 you may encounter a problem.
2849 @end deffn
2850
2851 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2852 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2853 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2854 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2855 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2856 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2857
2858 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2859 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2860 @quotation Tip
2861 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2862 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2863 @example
2864 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2865 > adapter_khz 500
2866 @end example
2867 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2868 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2869 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2870 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2871 large set of samples.
2872 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2873 @example
2874 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2875 @end example
2876 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2877 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2878
2879 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2880 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2881 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2882 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2883 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2884 @end quotation
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2888 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2889 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2893 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2894
2895 @example
2896 interface parport
2897 parport_port 0x278
2898 parport_cable wiggler
2899 @end example
2900 @end deffn
2901
2902 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2903 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2904 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2905 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2906 @end deffn
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2910 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2911 @end deffn
2912
2913 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2914 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2915 @end deffn
2916
2917 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2918 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2919
2920 @quotation Note
2921 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2922 which are not currently documented here.
2923 @end quotation
2924 @end deffn
2925
2926 @anchor{hla_interface}
2927 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2928 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2929 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2930 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2931
2932 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2933 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2934 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2935 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2936 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2937
2938 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2939 Currently Not Supported.
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2943 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2944 @end deffn
2945
2946 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2947 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2951 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2952 @end deffn
2953
2954 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2955 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2956 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2957 @end deffn
2958 @end deffn
2959
2960 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2961 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2965 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2966 @end deffn
2967
2968 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2969 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2970 @end deffn
2971
2972 @quotation Note
2973 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2974 which are not currently documented here.
2975 @end quotation
2976
2977 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2978 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2979 No arguments: print status.
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2983 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2984 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2985
2986 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2987 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2988 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2989 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2990 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2991 configuration on exit.
2992
2993 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2994 pinout.
2995
2996 @end deffn
2997
2998 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
2999 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3000 of the one which is most popular.
3001
3002 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3003
3004 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3005 pinout.
3006
3007 @end deffn
3008
3009
3010 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3011 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3012 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3013
3014 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3015 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3016 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3017
3018 @itemize @minus
3019 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3020 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3021 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3022 @end itemize
3023 @end deffn
3024
3025 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3026 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3027 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3028 @end deffn
3029 @end deffn
3030
3031 @section Transport Configuration
3032 @cindex Transport
3033 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3034 and the debug adapter you are using,
3035 several transports may be available to
3036 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3037 @deffn Command {transport list}
3038 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3039 version of OpenOCD.
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3043 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3044
3045 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3046 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3047 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3048 adapter's driver).
3049
3050 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3051 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3052 supported by the debug adapter.
3053
3054 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3055 transport, if any.
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @subsection JTAG Transport
3059 @cindex JTAG
3060 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3061 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3062 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3063 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3064 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3065 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3066
3067 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3068 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3069 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3070 hla_jtag}.
3071
3072 @subsection SWD Transport
3073 @cindex SWD
3074 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3075 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3076 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3077 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3078 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3079 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3080 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3081
3082 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3083 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3084 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3085 hla_swd}.
3086
3087 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3088 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3089 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3090 expected to change.
3091 @end deffn
3092 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3093 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3094 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3095 No parameters: displays current settings.
3096 @end deffn
3097
3098 @subsection SPI Transport
3099 @cindex SPI
3100 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3101 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3102 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3103 solution for flash programming.
3104
3105 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3106 @section JTAG Speed
3107 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3108 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3109 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3110 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3111 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3112 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3113 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3114 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3115 power management software that may be active.
3116
3117 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3118 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3119 target event handler.
3120 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3121 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3122 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3123 sets up those clocks).
3124 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3125 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3126 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3127 in the target config file.
3128 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3129 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3130 config file instead.
3131 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3132 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3133 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3134
3135 @example
3136 jtag_rclk 3000
3137 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3138 @end example
3139
3140 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3141 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3142 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3143 may not be the fastest solution.
3144
3145 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3146 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3147 which support adaptive clocking.
3148
3149 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3150 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3151 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3152 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3153 than the speed specified.
3154
3155 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3156 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3157 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3158 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3159
3160 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3161 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3162 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3163 JTAG clocking after setup.
3164 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3165 If the interface device can not
3166 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3167 @end deffn
3168
3169 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3170 @cindex adaptive clocking
3171 @cindex RTCK
3172 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3173 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3174 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3175 @example
3176 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3177 jtag_rclk 3000
3178 @end example
3179 @end defun
3180
3181 @node Reset Configuration
3182 @chapter Reset Configuration
3183 @cindex Reset Configuration
3184
3185 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3186 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3187 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3188 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3189 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3190 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3191 Please see the various board files for examples.
3192
3193 @quotation Note
3194 To maintainers and integrators:
3195 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3196 Normally the board configuration file
3197 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3198 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3199
3200 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3201 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3202 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3203 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3204 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3205 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3206 @end quotation
3207
3208 @section Types of Reset
3209
3210 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3211 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3212 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3213
3214 @itemize @bullet
3215 @item
3216 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3217 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3218 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3219 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3220 @item
3221 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3222 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3223 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3224 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3225 @item
3226 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3227 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3228 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3229 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3230 @item
3231 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3232 several other types of reset.
3233 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3234 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3235 There may be individual module resets.
3236 @end itemize
3237
3238 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3239 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3240 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3241 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3242 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3243 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3244 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3245 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3246 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3247
3248 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3249 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3250
3251 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3252 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3253 common issues are:
3254
3255 @itemize @bullet
3256
3257 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3258 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3259 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3260 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3261 when either of those signals is not connected.
3262 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3263 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3264 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3265 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3266
3267 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3268 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3269 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3270 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3271
3272 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3273 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3274 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3275 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3276 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3277 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3278 hardware debouncing.
3279 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3280 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3281
3282 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3283 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3284 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3285 to use push/pull output drivers.
3286 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3287 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3288 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3289 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3290
3291 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3292 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3293 issues (not limited to errata).
3294 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3295 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3296 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3297 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3298 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3299 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3300 @end itemize
3301
3302 There can also be other issues.
3303 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3304 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3305 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3306 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3307 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3308 Agreement (NDA).
3309
3310 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3311 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3312 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3313
3314 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3315 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3316
3317 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3318
3319 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3320 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3321 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3322 allowing it to be deasserted.
3323 @end deffn
3324
3325 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3326 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3327 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3328 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3329 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3330 @end deffn
3331
3332 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3333 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3334 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3335 allowing it to be deasserted.
3336 @end deffn
3337
3338 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3339 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3340 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3341 @end deffn
3342
3343 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3344 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3345 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3346 configuration scripts.
3347
3348 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3349 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3350 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3351 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3352 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3353 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3354 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3355 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3356
3357 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3358 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3359 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3360 -- may be specified at a time.
3361 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3362 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3363 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3364 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3365 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3366
3367 @itemize
3368 @item
3369 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3370 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3371 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3372 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3373 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3374
3375 @quotation Tip
3376 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3377 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3378 @end quotation
3379
3380 @item
3381 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3382 signal implementations.
3383 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3384 indicating everything behaves normally.
3385 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3386 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3387 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3388 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3389 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3390 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3391 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3392
3393 @item
3394 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3395 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3396 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3397 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3398 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3399 while SRST is asserted.
3400 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3401 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3402
3403 @item
3404 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3405 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3406 is required to use this option.
3407 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3408 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3409 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3410 be asserted before any target connection.
3411 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3412 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3413 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3414 @end itemize
3415
3416 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3417 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3418 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3419 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3420 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3421
3422 @itemize
3423 @item
3424 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3425 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3426 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3427 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3428
3429 @item
3430 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3431 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3432 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3433 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3434 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3435 @end itemize
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @section Custom Reset Handling
3439 @cindex events
3440
3441 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3442 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3443 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3444 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3445 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3446 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3447
3448 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3449 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3450 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3451 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3452 want to reset everything at once.
3453
3454 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3455 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3456 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3457 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3458 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3459 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3460 needs special attention.
3461
3462 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3463 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3464 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3465 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3466 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3467 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3468 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3469 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3470
3471 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3472 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3473 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3474 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3475 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3476
3477 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3478 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3479 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3480 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3481 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3482 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3483 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3484 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3485 or potentially some other value.
3486
3487 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3488 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3489 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3490 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3491 (or their associated targets)
3492 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3493
3494 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3495 they return.
3496 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3497 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3498 @end deffn
3499
3500 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3501 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3502 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3503 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3504 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3505 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3506 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3507 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3508 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3509 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3510 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3511 @end deffn
3512
3513 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3514 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3515 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3516 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3517 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3518 @end deffn
3519
3520
3521 @node TAP Declaration
3522 @chapter TAP Declaration
3523 @cindex TAP declaration
3524 @cindex TAP configuration
3525
3526 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3527 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3528
3529 @itemize @bullet
3530 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3531 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3532 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3533 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3534 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3535 start running that code.
3536 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3537 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3538 and missing connections.
3539 @end itemize
3540
3541 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3542 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3543 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3544 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3545 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3546
3547 @section Scan Chains
3548 @cindex scan chain
3549
3550 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3551 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3552 They also need to be added to
3553 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3554 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3555 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3556 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3557 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3558 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3559 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3560 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3561
3562 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3563 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3564 command, presented in the next chapter.
3565 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3566 debugging targets.)
3567 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3568
3569 @verbatim
3570 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3571 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3572 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3573 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3574 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3575 @end verbatim
3576
3577 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3578 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3579 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3580 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3581 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3582 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3583 until they are told to do so.
3584
3585 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3586 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3587 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3588 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3589
3590 @example
3591 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3592 @end example
3593
3594 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3595 by a given chip.
3596 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3597 and so forth.
3598 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3599 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3600 both inside a single chip and between them.
3601 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3602
3603 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3604 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3605 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3606 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3607 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3608 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3609 includes commands something like this:
3610
3611 @example
3612 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3613 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3614 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3615 @end example
3616
3617 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3618 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3619 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3620
3621 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3622 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3623 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3624 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3625 @example
3626 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3627 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3628 @}
3629 @end example
3630 @end deffn
3631
3632 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3633 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3634 and their status.
3635 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3636 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3637 but systems with a JTAG router can
3638 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3639 @end deffn
3640
3641 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3642 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3643
3644 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3645 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3646
3647 @section TAP Names
3648 @cindex dotted name
3649
3650 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3651 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3652 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3653 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3654 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3655 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3656 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3657 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3658
3659 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3660 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3661 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3662
3663 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3664
3665 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3666 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3667 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3668 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3669
3670 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3671 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3672 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3673 overridable.
3674
3675 @cindex TAP naming convention
3676 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3677 and should follow this convention:
3678
3679 @itemize @bullet
3680 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3681 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3682 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3683 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3684 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3685 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3686 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3687 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3688 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3689 with a single TAP;
3690 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3691 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3692 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3693 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3694 @end itemize
3695
3696 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3697
3698 @itemize @bullet
3699 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3700 @*The length in bits of the
3701 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3702 @end itemize
3703
3704 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3705
3706 @itemize @bullet
3707 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3708 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3709 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3710 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3711 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3712 (the TAP is linked in).
3713 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3714 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3715 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3716 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3717 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3718 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3719 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3720 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3721 values that were found but not included in the list.
3722
3723 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3724 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3725 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3726 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3727 hardware to find these values.
3728 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3729 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3730 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3731 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3732 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3733 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3734 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3735 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3736 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3737 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3738 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3739 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3740 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3741 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3742 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3743 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3744 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3745 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3746 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3747 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3748 @end itemize
3749 @end deffn
3750
3751 @section Other TAP commands
3752
3753 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3754 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3755 At this writing this TAP attribute
3756 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3757 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3758 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3759 See the next section for information about the available events.
3760
3761 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3762 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3763 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3764 @end deffn
3765
3766 @section TAP Events
3767 @cindex events
3768 @cindex TAP events
3769
3770 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3771 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3772 The other applies to debugger targets,
3773 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3774
3775 The TAP events currently defined are:
3776
3777 @itemize @bullet
3778 @item @b{post-reset}
3779 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3780 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3781 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3782 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3783 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3784
3785 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3786 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3787 of any particular target.
3788 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3789 @item @b{setup}
3790 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3791 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3792 @item @b{tap-disable}
3793 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3794 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3795 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3796 @item @b{tap-enable}
3797 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3798 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3799 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3800 @end itemize
3801
3802 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3803 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3804 contents to be accurate), you might:
3805
3806 @example
3807 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3808 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3809 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3810 @}
3811 @end example
3812
3813
3814 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3815 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3816 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3817 @cindex jrc
3818
3819 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3820 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3821 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3822 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3823 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3824
3825 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3826 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3827 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3828 be visible.
3829 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3830 ignores, such as:
3831
3832 @itemize
3833 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3834 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3835 TAPs receive new instructions.
3836 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3837 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3838 @end itemize
3839
3840 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3841 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3842 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3843 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3844
3845 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3846 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3847
3848 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3849 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3850 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3851 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3852 should define TAP event handlers using
3853 code that looks something like this:
3854
3855 @example
3856 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3857 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3858 @}
3859 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3860 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3861 @}
3862 @end example
3863
3864 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3865
3866 @example
3867 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3868 @end example
3869
3870 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3871 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3872 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3873 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3874
3875 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3876 If necessary, disables the tap
3877 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3878 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3879 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3880 and "0" if it is disabled.
3881 @end deffn
3882
3883 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3884 If necessary, enables the tap
3885 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3886 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3887 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3888 and "0" if it is disabled.
3889 @end deffn
3890
3891 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3892 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3893 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3894 and "0" if it is disabled.
3895
3896 @quotation Note
3897 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3898 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3899 @end quotation
3900 @end deffn
3901
3902 @anchor{autoprobing}
3903 @section Autoprobing
3904 @cindex autoprobe
3905 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3906
3907 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3908 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3909 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3910 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3911
3912 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3913 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3914 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3915 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3916 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3917 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3918 right when they come out of reset).
3919
3920 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3921
3922 @example
3923 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3924 reset_config trst_and_srst
3925 jtag_rclk 8
3926 @end example
3927
3928 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3929 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3930
3931 @enumerate
3932 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3933 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3934 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3935 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3936 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3937 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3938 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3939 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3940 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3941 that is discovered.
3942 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3943 register, it will report it.
3944 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3945 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3946 @end enumerate
3947
3948 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3949 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3950 that's a bit more complex:
3951
3952 @example
3953 clock speed 8 kHz
3954 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3955 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3956 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3957 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3958 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3959 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3960 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3961 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3962 @end example
3963
3964 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3965 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3966 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3967 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3968 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3969 and so forth.
3970
3971 @node CPU Configuration
3972 @chapter CPU Configuration
3973 @cindex GDB target
3974
3975 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3976 You can also access these targets without GDB
3977 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3978 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3979 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3980 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3981
3982 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3983 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3984
3985 @section Target List
3986 @cindex target, current
3987 @cindex target, list
3988
3989 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3990 where each member has a name.
3991 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3992 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3993 (plural!) command.
3994 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3995 look like with more than one:
3996 @verbatim
3997 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3998 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3999 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4000 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4001 @end verbatim
4002
4003 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4004 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4005 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4006 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4007 space seen by that current target.
4008 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4009 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4010 are examples; and there are many more.
4011
4012 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4013
4014 @deffn Command {target current}
4015 Returns the name of the current target.
4016 @end deffn
4017
4018 @deffn Command {target names}
4019 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4020 @example
4021 foreach t [target names] @{
4022 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4023 @}
4024 @end example
4025 @end deffn
4026
4027 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4028 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4029
4030 @deffn Command targets [name]
4031 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4032 command names are singular.}
4033
4034 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4035 targets in a user friendly form.
4036
4037 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4038 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4039 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4040 @end deffn
4041
4042 @section Target CPU Types
4043 @cindex target type
4044 @cindex CPU type
4045
4046 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4047 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4048 when calling @command{target create}.
4049 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4050 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4051 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4052 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4053 what core-specific commands may be available
4054 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4055 and more.
4056
4057 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4058 since there's a command to list them.
4059
4060 @anchor{targettypes}
4061 @deffn Command {target types}
4062 Lists all supported target types.
4063 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4064
4065 @itemize @bullet
4066 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4067 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4068 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4069 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4070 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4071 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4072 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4073 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4074 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4075 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4076 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4077 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4078 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4079 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4080 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4081 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4082 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4083 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4084 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4085 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4086 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4087 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4088 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4089 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4090 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4091 @itemize @minus
4092 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4093 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4094 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4095 @end itemize
4096 And two debug interfaces cores:
4097 @itemize @minus
4098 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4099 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4100 @end itemize
4101 @end itemize
4102 @end deffn
4103
4104 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4105 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4106 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4107 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4108 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4109 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4110 reflect design generations;
4111 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4112 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4113
4114 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4115 @section Target Configuration
4116
4117 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4118 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4119 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4120 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4121 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4122
4123 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4124 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4125 optional parts.
4126 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4127 command, created as part of target creation.
4128
4129 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4130 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4131 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4132 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4133 to be much more board-specific.
4134 The key steps you use might look something like this
4135
4136 @example
4137 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4138 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4139 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4140 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4141 @end example
4142
4143 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4144 on-chip SRAM.
4145 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4146 writes to target memory;
4147 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4148 GDB memory checksumming;
4149 and more.
4150
4151 @quotation Warning
4152 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4153 inaccessible when application code
4154 (such as an operating system)
4155 enables or disables the MMU.
4156 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4157 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4158 easy access to other addresses needed.
4159 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4160 @end quotation
4161
4162 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4163 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4164 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4165 controllers.
4166 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4167 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4168 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4169
4170 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4171 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4172 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4173 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4174 purposes including additional configuration.
4175
4176 @itemize @bullet
4177 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4178 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4179 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4180 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4181
4182 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4183 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4184 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4185 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4186 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4187 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4188 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4189
4190 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4191 @end itemize
4192 @end deffn
4193
4194 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4195 The options accepted by this command may also be
4196 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4197 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4198 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4199
4200 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4201 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4202 and changing its endianness.
4203
4204 @itemize @bullet
4205
4206 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4207 used to access this target.
4208
4209 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4210 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4211
4212 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4213 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4214 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4215 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4216 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4217 same event name assigns only one handler.
4218
4219 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4220 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4221 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4222 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4223 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4224 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4225 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4226
4227 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4228 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4229 or virtual address is being used.
4230
4231 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4232 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4233
4234 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4235 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4236 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4237 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4238 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4239
4240 @anchor{rtostype}
4241 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4242 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4243 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4244 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}
4245 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4246
4247 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4248 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4249 access the target for debugging.
4250
4251 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4252 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4253 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4254 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4255
4256 @item @code{-ctibase} @var{address} -- set base address of Cross-Trigger interface (CTI) connected
4257 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option, where it is
4258 a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4259 @end itemize
4260 @end deffn
4261
4262 @section Other $target_name Commands
4263 @cindex object command
4264
4265 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4266 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4267
4268 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4269 Once a button is created a button
4270 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4271 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4272 configure it like this:
4273
4274 @example
4275 # Create
4276 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4277 # Modify
4278 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4279 # Query
4280 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4281 # Report
4282 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4283 @end example
4284
4285 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4286 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4287
4288 @example
4289 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4290 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4291 @end example
4292
4293 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4294
4295 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4296 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4297 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4298 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4299 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4300 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4301 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4302 They are not otherwise documented here.
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4306 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4307 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4308 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4309 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4310 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4311 the target side uses raw memory.
4312
4313 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4314 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4315 The script orientation comes from working with data
4316 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4317 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4318 and neither store nor return those values.
4319
4320 @itemize
4321 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4322 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4323 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4324 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4325 @end itemize
4326 @end deffn
4327
4328 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4329 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4330 @command{$target_name configure}
4331 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4332 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4333 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4334 There are a few special cases:
4335
4336 @itemize @bullet
4337 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4338 event named @var{event_name}.
4339 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4340 two parameters.
4341 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4342 This is a special case because this is set using
4343 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4344 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4345 @end itemize
4346
4347 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4348 all the targets you might use something like this:
4349
4350 @example
4351 foreach name [target names] @{
4352 set y [$name cget -endian]
4353 set z [$name cget -type]
4354 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4355 $x $name $y $z]
4356 @}
4357 @end example
4358 @end deffn
4359
4360 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4361 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4362 Displays the current target state:
4363 @code{debug-running},
4364 @code{halted},
4365 @code{reset},
4366 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4367 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4368 @end deffn
4369
4370 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4371 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4372 currently associated with this target.
4373 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4374 @end deffn
4375
4376 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4377 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4378 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4379 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4380 @end deffn
4381
4382 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4383 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4384 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4385 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4386 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4387 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4388 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4389 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4390 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4391 @end deffn
4392
4393 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4394 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4395 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4396 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4397 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4398 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4399 @end deffn
4400
4401 @anchor{targetevents}
4402 @section Target Events
4403 @cindex target events
4404 @cindex events
4405 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4406 For example:
4407 @itemize @bullet
4408 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4409 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4410 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4411 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4412 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4413 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4414 to set up system clocks or
4415 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4416 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4417 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4418 @end itemize
4419
4420 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4421 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4422 @command{target create ... -event}.
4423
4424 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4425 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4426 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4427
4428 @example
4429 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4430 echo "Reset..."
4431 reset halt
4432 @}
4433 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4434 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4435 echo "Reset..."
4436 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4437 # we need a reset init.
4438 reset init
4439 @}
4440 @end example
4441
4442 The following target events are defined:
4443
4444 @itemize @bullet
4445 @item @b{debug-halted}
4446 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4447 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4448 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4449 @item @b{early-halted}
4450 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4451 @item @b{examine-start}
4452 @* Before target examine is called.
4453 @item @b{examine-end}
4454 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4455 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4456 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4457 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4458 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4459 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4460 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4461 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4462 @* When GDB disconnects
4463 @item @b{gdb-end}
4464 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4465 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4466 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4467 @code{reset init})
4468 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4469 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4470 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4471 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4472 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4473 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4474 @item @b{gdb-start}
4475 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4476 @item @b{halted}
4477 @* The target has halted
4478 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4479 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4480 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4481 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4482 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4483 @item @b{reset-assert}
4484 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4485 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4486 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4487 it instead of asserting SRST.
4488 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4489 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4490 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4491 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4492 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4493 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4494 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4495 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4496 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4497 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4498 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4499 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4500 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4501 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4502 released on the scan chain.
4503 @item @b{reset-end}
4504 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4505 @ignore
4506 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4507 @* Currently not used
4508 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4509 @* Currently not used
4510 @end ignore
4511 @item @b{reset-init}
4512 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4513 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4514
4515 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4516 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4517 multiplexing, and so on.
4518 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4519 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4520 @item @b{reset-start}
4521 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4522 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4523
4524 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4525 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4526 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4527 @ignore
4528 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4529 @* Currently not used
4530 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4531 @* Currently not used
4532 @end ignore
4533 @item @b{resume-start}
4534 @* Before any target is resumed
4535 @item @b{resume-end}
4536 @* After all targets have resumed
4537 @item @b{resumed}
4538 @* Target has resumed
4539 @item @b{trace-config}
4540 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4541 @end itemize
4542
4543 @node Flash Commands
4544 @chapter Flash Commands
4545
4546 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4547 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4548 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4549 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4550 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4551 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4552 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4553 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4554 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4555
4556 Flash Steps:
4557 @enumerate
4558 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4559 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4560 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4561 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4562 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4563 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4564 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4565 @item GDB Flashing
4566 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4567 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4568 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4569 @end enumerate
4570
4571 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4572 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4573 so that it can't boot.
4574 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4575 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4576
4577 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4578 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4579 @cindex flash configuration
4580
4581 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4582 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4583 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4584 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4585 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4586 see the driver-specific documentation.
4587
4588 @itemize @bullet
4589 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4590 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4591 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4592 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4593 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4594 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4595 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4596 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4597 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4598 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4599 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4600 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4601 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4602 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4603 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4604 commands to the flash controller.
4605 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4606 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4607 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4608 for more information.
4609 @end itemize
4610 @quotation Note
4611 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4612 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4613 @end quotation
4614 @end deffn
4615
4616 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4617 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4618 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4619 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4620 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4621 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4622 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4623 @end deffn
4624
4625 @deffn Command {flash list}
4626 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4627 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4628 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4629 @end deffn
4630
4631 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4632 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4633 depends on the flash type.
4634 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4635 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4636 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4637 but most don't bother.
4638 @end deffn
4639
4640 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4641 @cindex flash erasing
4642 @cindex flash reading
4643 @cindex flash writing
4644 @cindex flash programming
4645 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4646
4647 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4648 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4649 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4650 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4651 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4652
4653 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4654 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4655 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4656 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4657 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4658
4659 @quotation Note
4660 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4661 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4662 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4663 back to a flash bank.
4664 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4665 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4666 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4667 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4668 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4669 @end quotation
4670
4671 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4672 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4673 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4674 disabled first.
4675 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4676 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4677 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4678
4679 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4680 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4681 up to and including @var{last}.
4682 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4683 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4684 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4685 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4689 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4690 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4691 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4692 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4693 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4694 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4695 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4696 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4697 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4698 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4699 before erase starts.
4700 @end deffn
4701
4702 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4703 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4704 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4705 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4706 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4707 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4708 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4709 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4710 before issuing this command.
4711 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4712 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4713 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4714 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4715 @end deffn
4716 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4717
4718 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4719 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4720 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4721 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4722 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4723 @end deffn
4724
4725 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4726 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4727 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4728 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4729 @end deffn
4730
4731 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
4732 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4733 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
4734 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
4735 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4736 @end deffn
4737
4738 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4739 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4740 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4741 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4742 to the base address for each section in the image.
4743 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4744 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4745 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4746 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4747 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4748 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4749 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4750 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4751 each image section.
4752
4753 @quotation Warning
4754 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4755 data you want to preserve.
4756 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4757 sections might be erased with no notice.
4758 @itemize
4759 @item
4760 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4761 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4762 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4763 @item
4764 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4765 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4766 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4767 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4768 @end itemize
4769 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4770 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4771 @end quotation
4772
4773 @end deffn
4774
4775 @section Other Flash commands
4776 @cindex flash protection
4777
4778 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4779 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4780 and display that status.
4781 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4782 @end deffn
4783
4784 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4785 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4786 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4787
4788 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4789 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4790 and possibly stale information.
4791 @end deffn
4792
4793 @anchor{flashprotect}
4794 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4795 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
4796 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
4797 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4798 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
4799 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4800 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4801 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
4802 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
4803 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
4804 @end deffn
4805
4806 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4807 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4808 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4809 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4810 @end deffn
4811
4812 @anchor{program}
4813 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4814 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4815 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4816 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4817 @end deffn
4818
4819 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4820 @section Flash Driver List
4821 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4822 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4823 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4824
4825 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4826 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4827 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4828
4829 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4830
4831 @itemize
4832 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4833 @end itemize
4834
4835 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4836 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4837 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4838 @example
4839 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4840 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
4841 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4842 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
4843 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4844 @end example
4845 @end deffn
4846
4847 @subsection External Flash
4848
4849 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4850 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4851 @cindex CFI
4852 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4853 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4854 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4855 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4856 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4857 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4858 configure a bus and its timings), or
4859 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4860 on the flash chip.
4861 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4862 speed up operation.
4863
4864 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4865
4866 @itemize
4867 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4868 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4869 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4870 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4871 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4872 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4873 @end itemize
4874
4875 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4876 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4877
4878 @example
4879 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4880 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4881 @end example
4882
4883 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4884 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4885 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4886
4887 @example
4888 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4889 @end example
4890
4891 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4892 @end deffn
4893
4894 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4895 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4896 @cindex SPI
4897 @cindex jtagspi
4898 @cindex bscan_spi
4899 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4900 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4901 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4902 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4903 accessed through JTAG.
4904
4905 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4906 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4907 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4908 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4909 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
4910 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4911
4912 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4913 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4914 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4915 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4916 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4917 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4918 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4919 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4920
4921 @itemize
4922 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4923 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4924 @var{USER1} instruction.
4925 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4926 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4927 @end itemize
4928
4929 @example
4930 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4931 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4932 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
4934 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4935 @end example
4936 @end deffn
4937
4938 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4939 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4940 @cindex SPIFI
4941 @cindex lpcspifi
4942 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4943 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4944 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4945
4946 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4947 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4948 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4949 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4950 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4951
4952 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4953 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4954 are configured by the driver.
4955
4956 @example
4957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4958 @end example
4959
4960 @end deffn
4961
4962 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4963 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4964 @cindex SMI
4965 @cindex stmsmi
4966 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4967 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4968 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4969 SPI flash devices.
4970 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4971 flash devices can be connected.
4972
4973 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4974 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4975 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4976 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4977 the flash content.
4978
4979 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4980 to identify the memory bank.
4981 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4982 flash size, are detected automatically.
4983
4984 @example
4985 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4986 @end example
4987
4988 @end deffn
4989
4990 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4991 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4992 Microcontroller platform.
4993
4994 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4995 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4996
4997 @example
4998 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4999 @end example
5000
5001 @end deffn
5002
5003 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5004 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5005 @cindex ath79
5006 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5007 chip selects.
5008 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5009 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5010 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5011 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5012 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5013 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5014
5015 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5016 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5017 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5018 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5019 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5020 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5021 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5022 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5023 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5024 with the default CS0.
5025 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5026 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5027 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5028
5029 @example
5030 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5031
5032 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5033 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5034 # banks.
5035 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5036 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5037 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5038 @end example
5039
5040 @end deffn
5041
5042 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5043
5044 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5045 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5046 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5047 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5048 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5049 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5050
5051 @example
5052 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5053 @end example
5054 @end deffn
5055
5056 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5057 @cindex ambiqmicro
5058 @cindex apollo
5059 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5060 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5061 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5062 with the target using SWD.
5063
5064 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5065 the device class of the MCU.
5066 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5067 to set up the flash banks.
5068 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5069 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5070
5071 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5072 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5073 and the second bank starts after the first.
5074
5075 @example
5076 # Flash bank 0
5077 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5078 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5079 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5080 $_TARGETNAME
5081 @end example
5082
5083 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5084 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5085 are available to the user.
5086
5087 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5088
5089 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5090 Erase entire bank.
5091 @end deffn
5092 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5093 Erase device pages.
5094 @end deffn
5095 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5096 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5097 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5098 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5099 the flash.
5100 @end deffn
5101 @end deffn
5102
5103 @anchor{at91samd}
5104 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5105 @cindex at91samd
5106 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5107 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5108 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5109
5110 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5111 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5112 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5113 processor to be halted.
5114 @end deffn
5115
5116 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5117 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5118 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5119 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5120 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5121 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5122
5123 @example
5124 at91samd set-security enable
5125 @end example
5126 @end deffn
5127
5128 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5129 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5130 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5131 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5132 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5133 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5134 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5135 in order to disable this feature.
5136
5137 @example
5138 at91samd eeprom
5139 at91samd eeprom 1024
5140 @end example
5141 @end deffn
5142
5143 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5144 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5145 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5146 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5147 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5148 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5149
5150 @example
5151 at91samd bootloader
5152 at91samd bootloader 16384
5153 @end example
5154 @end deffn
5155
5156 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5157 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5158 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5159 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5160 @end deffn
5161
5162 @end deffn
5163
5164 @anchor{at91sam3}
5165 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5166 @cindex at91sam3
5167 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5168 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5169 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5170 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5171 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5172 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5173 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5174 chips are confirmed.}
5175
5176 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5177 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5178 the following fixed locations:
5179
5180 @example
5181 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5182 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5183 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5184 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5185 @end example
5186
5187 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5188 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5189 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5190
5191 @itemize
5192 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5193 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5194 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5195 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5196 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5197 @end itemize
5198
5199 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5200
5201 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5202 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5203 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5204 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5205 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5206 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5207 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5208
5209 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5210 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5211 @end deffn
5212
5213 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5214 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5215 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5216 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5217 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5218 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5219 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5220 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5221 @end deffn
5222
5223 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5224 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5225 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5226 @end deffn
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5230 @cindex at91sam4
5231 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5232 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5233 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5234 @end deffn
5235
5236 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5237 @cindex at91sam4l
5238 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5239 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5240 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5241
5242 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5243 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5244 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5245 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5246 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5247 @end deffn
5248 @end deffn
5249
5250 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5251 @cindex atsamv
5252 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5253 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5254 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5255 @end deffn
5256
5257 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5258 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5259 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5260 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5261 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5262
5263 @example
5264 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5265 @end example
5266
5267 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5268 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5269
5270 @itemize
5271 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5272 @item @var{banks}
5273 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5274 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5275 @item @var{pages_size}
5276 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5277 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5278 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5279 @end itemize
5280
5281 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5282 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5283 will be autoconfigured.
5284 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5285
5286 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5287 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5288 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5289 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5290 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5291
5292 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5293 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5294 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5295 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5296 are not truly general purpose).
5297 @quotation Note
5298 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5299 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5300 @end quotation
5301 @end deffn
5302 @end deffn
5303
5304 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5305 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5306 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5307 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5308 @end deffn
5309
5310 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5311 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5312 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5313 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5314 autoconfigures itself.
5315 @example
5316 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5317 @end example
5318 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5319 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5320 this via the following command:
5321 @example
5322 efm32 debuglock num
5323 @end example
5324 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5325 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5326 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5327 supported.}
5328 @end deffn
5329
5330 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5331 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5332 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5333 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5334 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5335 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5336 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5337
5338 @example
5339 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5340 @end example
5341 @end deffn
5342
5343 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5344 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5345 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5346 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5347 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5348 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5349 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5350 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5351 characters) ignored.
5352
5353 @example
5354 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5355 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5356 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5357 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5358 @end example
5359 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5360 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5361 @end deffn
5362
5363 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5364 @cindex kinetis
5365 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5366 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5367 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5368 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5369 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5370 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x devices.
5371
5372 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5373 @itemize
5374 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5375 @end itemize
5376
5377 @example
5378 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5379 @end example
5380
5381 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5382 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5383 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5384 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5385 @end deffn
5386
5387 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5388 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5389 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5390 set by 'flash protect' command.
5391 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5392 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5393 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5394 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5395 with the rest of a flash image.
5396 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5397 @end deffn
5398
5399 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5400 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5401 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5402 @end deffn
5403
5404 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5405 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5406 @end deffn
5407
5408 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5409 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5410 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5411 @end deffn
5412
5413 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5414 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5415 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5416 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5417 command completes.
5418 @end deffn
5419
5420 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5421 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5422 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5423 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5424 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5425
5426 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5427 Program Partition command.
5428
5429 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5430 Reset the device after partition setting.
5431
5432 Show partition size:
5433 @example
5434 kinetis nvm_partition info
5435 @end example
5436
5437 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5438 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5439 @example
5440 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5441 @end example
5442
5443 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5444 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5445 @example
5446 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5447 @end example
5448 @end deffn
5449
5450 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5451 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5452 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5453 @end deffn
5454
5455 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5456 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5457 Command disables watchdog timer.
5458 @end deffn
5459 @end deffn
5460
5461 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5462 @cindex kinetis_ke
5463 KE0x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5464 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5465 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5466 autoconfigures itself.
5467 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5468
5469 @example
5470 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5471 @end example
5472
5473 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5474 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5475 @end deffn
5476
5477 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5478 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5479 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5480 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5481 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5482 @end deffn
5483
5484 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5485 Command disables watchdog timer.
5486 @end deffn
5487 @end deffn
5488
5489 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5490 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5491 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5492 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5493 microcontroller families from NXP.
5494
5495 @quotation Note
5496 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5497 driver:
5498 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5499 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5500 @end quotation
5501
5502 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5503 which must appear in the following order:
5504
5505 @itemize
5506 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5507 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5508 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5509 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5510 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5511 LPC43x[2357])
5512 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5513 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5514 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5515 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5516 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5517 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5518 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5519 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5520 at which the core is running
5521 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5522 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5523 @quotation Note
5524 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5525 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5526 However, if you do provide it,
5527 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5528 @end quotation
5529 @end itemize
5530
5531 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5532
5533 @example
5534 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5535 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5536 @end example
5537
5538 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5539 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5540 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5541 @end deffn
5542 @end deffn
5543
5544 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5545 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5546 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5547 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5548 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5549 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5550
5551 @example
5552 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5553 @end example
5554 @end deffn
5555
5556 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5557 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5558 from NXP.
5559
5560 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5561 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5562 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5563 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5564 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5565 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5566 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5567 you start the PLL.
5568
5569 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5570
5571 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5572 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5573 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5574
5575 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5576 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5577 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5578 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5579 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5580 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5581 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5582
5583 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5584 @example
5585 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5586 @end example
5587
5588 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5589 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5590 @code{flash banks} command.
5591
5592 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5593 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5594 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5595 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5596 a known signature.
5597 Example:
5598 @example
5599 lpc2900 signature 0
5600 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5601 @end example
5602 @end deffn
5603
5604 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5605 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5606 saves it to a file in binary format.
5607 Example:
5608 @example
5609 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5610 @end example
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5614 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5615 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5616 command:
5617
5618 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5619 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5620 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5621 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5622
5623 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5624 Example:
5625 @example
5626 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5627 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5628 @end example
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5632 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5633 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5634 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5635 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5636 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5637 912 bytes.
5638 @quotation Attention
5639 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5640 @end quotation
5641 Example:
5642 @example
5643 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5644 @end example
5645 @end deffn
5646
5647 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5648 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5649 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5650 after the next power cycle.
5651 @quotation Attention
5652 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5653 @end quotation
5654 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5655 Example:
5656 @example
5657 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5658 flash info 0
5659 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5660 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5661 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5662 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5663 @end example
5664 @end deffn
5665
5666 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5667 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5668 effective after the next power cycle.
5669 @quotation Attention
5670 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5671 @end quotation
5672 Examples:
5673 @example
5674 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5675 @end example
5676 @end deffn
5677 @end deffn
5678
5679 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5680 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5681 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5682 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5683
5684 @example
5685 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5686 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5687 @end example
5688
5689 @itemize @bullet
5690 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5691 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5692 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5693 @end itemize
5694
5695 Example usage:
5696 @example
5697 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5698 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5699 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5700 @} else @{
5701 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5702 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5703 @}
5704 @end example
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5708 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5709 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5710 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5711 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5712 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5713 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5714 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5715 also have division into regions: main and info.
5716 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5717 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5718
5719 @example
5720 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5721 @end example
5722
5723 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5724
5725 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5726 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5727 @end deffn
5728
5729 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5730 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5731 @end deffn
5732
5733 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5734 Erase all userflash including info region.
5735 @end deffn
5736
5737 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5738 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5742 Check sectors protect.
5743 @end deffn
5744
5745 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5746 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5750 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5751 @end deffn
5752
5753 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5754 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5755 @end deffn
5756
5757 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5758 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5759 @end deffn
5760
5761 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5762 Show information about flash driver.
5763 @end deffn
5764
5765 @end deffn
5766
5767 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5768 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5769 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5770
5771 @example
5772 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5773 @end example
5774
5775 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5776
5777 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5778 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5779 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5780 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5781 code.
5782 @end deffn
5783
5784 @end deffn
5785
5786 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5787 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5788 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5789
5790 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5791 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5792 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5793 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5794
5795 @example
5796 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5797 @end example
5798 @end deffn
5799
5800 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5801 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5802 and integrate flash memory.
5803
5804 @example
5805 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5806 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5807 @end example
5808
5809 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5810 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5811 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5812 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5813 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5814 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5815 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5816 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5817 @end deffn
5818 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5819 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5820 This will remove any Code Protection.
5821 @end deffn
5822 @end deffn
5823
5824 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5825 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5826 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5827 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5828 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5829
5830 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5831 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5832
5833 @example
5834 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5835 @end example
5836
5837 psoc4-specific commands
5838 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5839 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5840
5841 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5842 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5843
5844 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5845 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5846 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5847
5848 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5849 @end deffn
5850
5851 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5852 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5853
5854 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5855 @end deffn
5856 @end deffn
5857
5858 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5859 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5860 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5861 and SWD interface.
5862 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5863 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5864
5865 @example
5866 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5867 @end example
5868
5869 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5870
5871 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5872 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5873 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5874 @end deffn
5875
5876 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5877 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5878 @end deffn
5879 @end deffn
5880
5881 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5882 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5883 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5884 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5885 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5886 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5887 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5888 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5889
5890 @example
5891 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5892 @end example
5893
5894 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5895 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5896 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5897 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5898 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5899 disabled.
5900
5901 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5902 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5903 @quotation Warning
5904 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5905 applied to all of them.
5906 @end quotation
5907 @end deffn
5908 @end deffn
5909
5910 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5911 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5912 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5913 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5914 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5915
5916 @example
5917 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5918 @end example
5919
5920 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5921 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5922 the flash driver.
5923
5924 @example
5925 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5926 @end example
5927
5928 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5929 as per the following example.
5930 @example
5931 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5932 @end example
5933
5934 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5935 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5936 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5937 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5938 are defined:
5939
5940 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5941 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5942 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5943 @end deffn
5944
5945 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5946 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5947 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5948 @end deffn
5949
5950 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5951 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5952 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5953 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5954 @end deffn
5955
5956 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5957 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5958 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5959 @end deffn
5960 @end deffn
5961
5962 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5963 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5964 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
5965 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5966 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5967
5968 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5969 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5970 the flash driver.
5971
5972 @example
5973 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5974 @end example
5975
5976 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5977
5978 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5979 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5980 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5981 @end deffn
5982
5983 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5984 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5985 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5986 @end deffn
5987
5988 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
5989 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1.
5990 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
5994 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
5995 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
5996 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, user_options a
5997 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, boot_addr0 and boot_addr1
5998 two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
5999 @end deffn
6000 @end deffn
6001
6002 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6003 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6004 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6005 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6006 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6007
6008 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6009 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6010 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6011 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6012 second bank.
6013
6014 @example
6015 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6016 @end example
6017
6018 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6019
6020 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6021 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6022 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6023 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6024 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6025 @end deffn
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6029 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6030 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6031 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6032 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6033
6034 @example
6035 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6036 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6037 @end example
6038
6039 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6040 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6041 for the specified flash bank.
6042 @end deffn
6043 @end deffn
6044
6045 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6046 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6047 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6048 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6049 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6050
6051 @example
6052 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6053 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6054 @end example
6055
6056 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6057 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6058 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6059
6060 @itemize @bullet
6061 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6062 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6063 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6064 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6065 @end itemize
6066 @end deffn
6067
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6071 @cindex str9xpec
6072
6073 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6074 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6075 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6076 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6077
6078 Here is some background info to help
6079 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6080 the str9:
6081 @enumerate
6082 @item
6083 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6084 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6085 @item
6086 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6087 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6088 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6089 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6090 @end enumerate
6091
6092 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6093 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6094 configured for flash bank 0.
6095 @example
6096 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6097 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6098 jtag_reset 0 1
6099 # turn off target polling
6100 poll off
6101 # disable str9 core
6102 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6103 # read option bytes
6104 str9xpec options_read 0
6105 # re-enable str9 core
6106 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6107 poll on
6108 reset halt
6109 @end example
6110 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6111 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6112 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6113 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6114
6115 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6116
6117 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6118 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6119 @end deffn
6120
6121 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6122 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6123 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6124 @end deffn
6125
6126 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6127 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6128 erase the device.
6129 @end deffn
6130
6131 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6132 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6133 @end deffn
6134
6135 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6136 Configure str9 boot bank.
6137 @end deffn
6138
6139 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6140 Configure str9 lvd source.
6141 @end deffn
6142
6143 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6144 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6145 @end deffn
6146
6147 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6148 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6149 @end deffn
6150
6151 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6152 Read str9 option bytes.
6153 @end deffn
6154
6155 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6156 Write str9 option bytes.
6157 @end deffn
6158
6159 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6160 unlock str9 device.
6161 @end deffn
6162
6163 @end deffn
6164
6165 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6166 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6167 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6168 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6169
6170 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6171
6172 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6173 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6177 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6178 @end deffn
6179
6180 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6181 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6182 the flash clock.
6183 @end deffn
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6187 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6188 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6189 @end deffn
6190
6191 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6192 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6193 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6194
6195 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6196
6197 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6198 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6199 @end deffn
6200
6201 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6202 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6203 @end deffn
6204
6205 @end deffn
6206
6207 @section NAND Flash Commands
6208 @cindex NAND
6209
6210 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6211 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6212 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6213
6214 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6215 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6216 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6217 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6218 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6219 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6220
6221 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6222 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6223 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6224 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6225 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6226 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6227 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6228 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6229 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6230 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6231
6232 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6233 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6234 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6235 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6236 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6237 every 512 bytes of data.
6238
6239 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6240 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6241 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6242 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6243 ECC mode is used.
6244
6245 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6246 @enumerate
6247 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6248 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6249 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6250 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6251 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6252 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6253 to access that device.
6254 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6255 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6256 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6257 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6258 de-brick a board.
6259 @end enumerate
6260
6261 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6262 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6263 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6264 are only 32 bits wide.
6265 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6266 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6267 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6268 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6269
6270 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6271 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6272 @cindex NAND configuration
6273
6274 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6275 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6276 OpenOCD has initialized.
6277
6278 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6279 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6280 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6281 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6282 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6283 they were a single (larger) device.
6284 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6285 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6286
6287 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6288 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6289 configuration files, not interactively.
6290
6291 @itemize @bullet
6292 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6293 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6294 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6295 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6296 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6297 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6298 commands to the NAND controller.
6299 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6300 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6301 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6302 for more information.
6303 @end itemize
6304 @end deffn
6305
6306 @deffn Command {nand list}
6307 Prints a summary of each device declared
6308 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6309 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6310 @example
6311 > nand list
6312 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6313 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6314 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6315 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6316 >
6317 @end example
6318 @end deffn
6319
6320 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6321 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6322 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6323 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6324 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6325 it with most other NAND commands.
6326 @end deffn
6327
6328 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6329
6330 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6331 @cindex NAND reading
6332 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6333 starting at the specified offset.
6334 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6335
6336 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6337 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6338
6339 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6340 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6341 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6342
6343 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6344 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6345 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6346 method which handled that error correction.
6347
6348 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6349 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6350 @itemize @bullet
6351 @item no oob_* parameter
6352 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6353 @item @code{oob_raw}
6354 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6355 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6356 spare areas associated with each data page.
6357 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6358 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6359 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6360 @item @code{oob_only}
6361 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6362 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6363 spare areas associated with each data page.
6364 @end itemize
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6368 @cindex NAND erasing
6369 @cindex NAND programming
6370 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6371 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6372 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6373 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6374 If those parameters are not specified,
6375 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6376 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6377
6378 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6379 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6380 block marker.
6381 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6382 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6386 @cindex NAND writing
6387 @cindex NAND programming
6388 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6389 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6390 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6391 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6392
6393 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6394 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6395
6396 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6397 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6398 past the end of the device.
6399 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6400 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6401 if that's being written.)
6402
6403 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6404 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6405 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6406
6407 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6408 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6409 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6410 @itemize @bullet
6411 @item no oob_* parameter
6412 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6413 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6414 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6415 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6416 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6417 @item @code{oob_only}
6418 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6419 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6420 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6421 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6422 @item @code{oob_raw}
6423 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6424 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6425 un-altered OOB.
6426 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6427 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6428 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6429 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6430 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6431 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6432 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6433 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6434 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6435 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6436 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6437 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6438 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6439 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6440 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6441 @end itemize
6442 @end deffn
6443
6444 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6445 @cindex NAND verification
6446 @cindex NAND programming
6447 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6448 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6449 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6450
6451 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6452 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6453
6454 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6455 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6456 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6457 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6458 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6459
6460 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6461 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6462 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6463
6464 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6465 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6466 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6467 be removed in a future release.
6468 @end deffn
6469
6470 @subsection Other NAND commands
6471 @cindex NAND other commands
6472
6473 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6474 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6475 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6476 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6477 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6478 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6479 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6480 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6481
6482 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6483 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6484 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6485 @end deffn
6486
6487 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6488 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6489 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6490 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6491 status for each block.
6492 @end deffn
6493
6494 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6495 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6496 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6497
6498 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6499 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6500 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6501 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6502 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6503
6504 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6505 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6506 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6507 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6508 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6509 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6510 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6511 @end deffn
6512
6513 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6514 @subsection NAND Driver List
6515 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6516 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6517 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6518
6519 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6520 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6521 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6522 address of the ECC controller.
6523 @example
6524 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6525 @end example
6526 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6527 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6528 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6529 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6530 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6531 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6532 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6533 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6534 @end deffn
6535 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6536 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6537 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6541 properly configured for input or output.
6542 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6543 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6544 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6545 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6546 @end deffn
6547 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6548 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6549 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6550 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6551 @end deffn
6552 @end deffn
6553
6554 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6555 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6556 chips from Texas Instruments.
6557 It takes three extra parameters:
6558 address of the NAND chip;
6559 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6560 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6561 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6562 @example
6563 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6564 @end example
6565 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6566 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6567 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6568 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6569 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6570 @end deffn
6571
6572 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6573 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6574 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6575 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6576 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6577 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6578 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6579 @end deffn
6580
6581 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6582 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6583 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6584 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6585 @end deffn
6586 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6587
6588 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6589 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6590 should work for this chip aswell.
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6594 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6595 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6596 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6597 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6598 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6599 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6600 @example
6601 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6602 @end example
6603 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6604 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6605 without parameter query status.
6606 @end deffn
6607 @end deffn
6608
6609 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6610 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6611 parameter: the address of the controller.
6612 @example
6613 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6614 @end example
6615 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6616 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6617 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6618 change any behavior.
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6622 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6623 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6624 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6625 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6626 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6627 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6628 specialized commands.
6629 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6630 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6631 change any behavior.
6632 @end deffn
6633
6634 @section mFlash
6635
6636 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6637 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6638
6639 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6640 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6641 address @var{base}.
6642 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6643 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6644
6645 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6646
6647 @example
6648 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6649 @end example
6650
6651 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6652
6653 @example
6654 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6655 @end example
6656 @end deffn
6657
6658 @subsection mFlash commands
6659 @cindex mFlash commands
6660
6661 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6662 Configure mflash PLL.
6663 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6664 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6665 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6666 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6670 Configure bootable option.
6671 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6672 (4kB) for boot.
6673 @end deffn
6674
6675 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6676 Configure storage information.
6677 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6678 written.
6679 @end deffn
6680
6681 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6682 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6683 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6684 @end deffn
6685
6686 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6687 Probe mflash.
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6691 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6692 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 @node Flash Programming
6696 @chapter Flash Programming
6697
6698 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6699 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6700 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6701
6702 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6703 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6704
6705 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6706 @enumerate
6707 @item 'init' is executed.
6708 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6709 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6710 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6711 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6712 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6713 @end enumerate
6714
6715 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6716
6717 @example
6718 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6719 # are optional parameters
6720 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6721 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6722
6723 # binary files need the flash address passing
6724 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6725 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6726 @end example
6727
6728 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6729 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6730 @cindex PLD
6731 @cindex FPGA
6732
6733 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6734 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6735 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6736 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6737 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6738 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6739 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6740
6741 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6742
6743 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6744 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6745 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6746
6747 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6748 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6749
6750 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6751 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6752 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6753 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6754 behavior.
6755 @end deffn
6756
6757 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6758 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6762 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6763 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6767
6768 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6769 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6770 that particular type of PLD.
6771
6772 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6773 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6774 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6775
6776 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6777 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6778 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6779
6780 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6781 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6782 for FPGA @var{num}.
6783 @end deffn
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @node General Commands
6787 @chapter General Commands
6788 @cindex commands
6789
6790 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6791 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6792 commands are documented elsewhere.
6793
6794 Intent:
6795 @itemize @bullet
6796 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6797 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6798 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6799 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6800
6801 @item @b{From the human}
6802 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6803 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6804
6805 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6806 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6807 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6808
6809 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6810 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6811 port is 5555.
6812 @end itemize
6813
6814
6815 @section Server Commands
6816
6817 @deffn {Command} exit
6818 Exits the current telnet session.
6819 @end deffn
6820
6821 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6822 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6823 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6824 Not every command provides helptext.
6825
6826 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6827 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6828 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6829 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6830 @end deffn
6831
6832 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6833 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6834 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6835 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6836 Useful in connection with script files
6837 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6841 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6842 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6843 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @anchor{debuglevel}
6847 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6848 @cindex message level
6849 Display debug level.
6850 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6851 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6852 Level 0 is error messages only;
6853 level 1 adds warnings;
6854 level 2 adds informational messages;
6855 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6856 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6857 the command line along with the location of that log
6858 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6859 @xref{Running}.
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6863 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6864 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6865 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6866 @example
6867 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6868 @end example
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6872 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6873 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6877 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6878 @end deffn
6879
6880 @deffn Command bindto [name]
6881 Specify address by name on which to listen for incoming TCP/IP connections.
6882 By default, OpenOCD will listen on all available interfaces.
6883 @end deffn
6884
6885 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6886 @section Target State handling
6887 @cindex reset
6888 @cindex halt
6889 @cindex target initialization
6890
6891 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6892 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6893 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6894 a current target which is used to perform the
6895 various operations. The current target may be changed
6896 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6897 target which should become current.
6898
6899 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6900 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6901 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6902 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6903 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6904
6905 @emph{With no arguments}:
6906 list all available registers for the current target,
6907 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6908 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6909 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6910 are flagged as such.
6911
6912 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6913 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6914 bypassing any internal cache.
6915
6916 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6917 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6918 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6919 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6920 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6921 relevant module will flush such values.
6922
6923 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6924 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6925
6926 @example
6927 > reg
6928 ===== ARM registers
6929 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6930 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6931 (2) r2 (/32)
6932 ...
6933 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6934 >
6935 @end example
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6939 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6940 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6941 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6942 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6943 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6944 (and enter debug mode).
6945 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6946
6947 @quotation Warning
6948 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6949 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6950 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6951 power mode by gating the core clock;
6952 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6953
6954 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6955 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6956 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6957 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6958 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6959 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6960
6961 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6962 work with a JTAG debugger.
6963 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6964 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6965 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6966 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6967 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6968 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6969 @end quotation
6970
6971 @end deffn
6972
6973 @deffn Command resume [address]
6974 Resume the target at its current code position,
6975 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6976 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @deffn Command step [address]
6980 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6981 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @anchor{resetcommand}
6985 @deffn Command reset
6986 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6987 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6988 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6989 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6990 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6991 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6992
6993 The optional parameter specifies what should
6994 happen after the reset.
6995 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6996 The other options will not work on all systems.
6997 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6998
6999 @itemize @minus
7000 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7001 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7002 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7003 @end itemize
7004 @end deffn
7005
7006 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7007 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7008 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7009 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7010 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7011 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7012 state.
7013 @end deffn
7014
7015 @section I/O Utilities
7016
7017 These commands are available when
7018 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7019 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7020 notably the ZY1000.
7021 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7022
7023 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7024
7025 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7026 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7027 the text file @file{filename}.
7028 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7029 The last string is followed by a newline.
7030 @end deffn
7031
7032 @deffn Command cat filename
7033 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7034 @end deffn
7035
7036 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7037 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7038 into @file{dest_filename}.
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn Command ip
7042 @emph{No description provided.}
7043 @end deffn
7044
7045 @deffn Command ls
7046 @emph{No description provided.}
7047 @end deffn
7048
7049 @deffn Command mac
7050 @emph{No description provided.}
7051 @end deffn
7052
7053 @deffn Command meminfo
7054 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7055 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7056 @end deffn
7057
7058 @deffn Command peek
7059 @emph{No description provided.}
7060 @end deffn
7061
7062 @deffn Command poke
7063 @emph{No description provided.}
7064 @end deffn
7065
7066 @deffn Command rm filename
7067 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7068 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn Command trunc filename
7072 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7076 @section Memory access commands
7077 @cindex memory access
7078
7079 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7080 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7081 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7082 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7083
7084 @enumerate
7085 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7086 to change the current target.
7087 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7088 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7089 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7090 @end enumerate
7091
7092 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7093 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7094 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7095 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7096 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7097 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7098 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7099 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7100 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7101 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7102 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7103 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7104 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7105 @end deffn
7106
7107 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7108 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7109 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7110 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7111 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7112 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7113 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7114 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7115 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7116 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7117 @end deffn
7118
7119 @anchor{imageaccess}
7120 @section Image loading commands
7121 @cindex image loading
7122 @cindex image dumping
7123
7124 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7125 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7126 binary file named @var{filename}.
7127 @end deffn
7128
7129 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7130 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7131 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
7132 @end deffn
7133
7134 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7135 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7136 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7137 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7138 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7139 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7140 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7141 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7142 separately.
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7146 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7147 The file format may optionally be specified
7148 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7149 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7150 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7151 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7152 @example
7153 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7154 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7155 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7156 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7157 $address $length
7158 @}
7159 @end example
7160 @end deffn
7161
7162 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7163 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7164 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7165 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7166 The file format may optionally be specified
7167 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7168 @end deffn
7169
7170 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7171 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7172 The file format may optionally be specified
7173 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7174 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7178 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7179 The file format may optionally be specified
7180 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7181 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184
7185 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7186 @cindex breakpoint
7187 @cindex watchpoint
7188
7189 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7190 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7191 watchpoints.
7192 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7193
7194 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7195 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7196 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7197 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7198 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7199 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7200
7201 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7202 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7203 @end deffn
7204
7205 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7206 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7207 @end deffn
7208
7209 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7210 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7214 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7215 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7216 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7217 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7218 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7219 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7220 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7221 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @section Misc Commands
7225
7226 @cindex profiling
7227 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7228 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7229 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7230 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7231 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7232 limit the address range.
7233 @end deffn
7234
7235 @deffn Command {version}
7236 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7237 @end deffn
7238
7239 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7240 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7241 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7242 @end deffn
7243
7244 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7245 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7246 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7247 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7248
7249 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7250 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7251 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7252 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7253
7254 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7255 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7256 @cindex tracing
7257 @cindex ETM
7258 @cindex ETB
7259
7260 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7261 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7262 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7263
7264 @itemize
7265 @item
7266 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7267 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7268 supports such an interface.
7269 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7270 and trace port support.)
7271 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7272 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7273 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7274 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7275 in the board-specific configuration file.
7276 @item
7277 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7278 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7279 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7280 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7281 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7282 @end itemize
7283
7284 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7285
7286 @quotation Issues
7287 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7288 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7289
7290 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7291 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7292 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7293 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7294 dummy trace port driver}.
7295
7296 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7297 as well as tracing only during specific states
7298 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7299
7300 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7301 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7302 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7303 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7304 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7305
7306 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7307 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7308 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7309 this original style of JTAG access.
7310 @end quotation
7311
7312 @subsection ETM Configuration
7313 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7314
7315 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7316 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7317 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7318
7319 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7320 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7321 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7322 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7323 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7324 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7325 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7326 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7327 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7328
7329 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7330 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7331 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7332
7333 @quotation Warning
7334 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7335 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7336 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7337 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7338 @end quotation
7339
7340 @quotation Note
7341 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7342 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7343 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7344 what CPU activities are traced.
7345 @end quotation
7346 @end deffn
7347
7348 @deffn Command {etm info}
7349 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7350 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7351 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7352 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7353 @end deffn
7354
7355 @deffn Command {etm status}
7356 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7357 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7358 Did trace data overflow?
7359 Was it triggered?
7360 @end deffn
7361
7362 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7363 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7364 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7365 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7366 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7367
7368 @itemize
7369 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7370 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7371 The value is one of
7372 @option{none} (save nothing),
7373 @option{data} (save data),
7374 @option{address} (save addresses),
7375 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7376 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7377 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7378 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7379 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7380 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7381 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7382 trace stream without an image of the code.
7383 @end itemize
7384 @end deffn
7385
7386 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7387 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7388 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7389 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7390 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7391
7392 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7393 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7394 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7398
7399 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7400 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7401 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7402
7403 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7404 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7405 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7406 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7407 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7408 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7409 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7410
7411 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7412
7413 @itemize
7414 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7415 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7416 for instruction access within that function's body.
7417 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7418 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7419 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7420 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7421 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7422 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7423 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7424 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7425 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7426 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7427 @item @emph{... more}
7428 @end itemize
7429
7430 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7431 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7432
7433 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7434 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7435 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7436 @end deffn
7437
7438 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7439 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7440 @end deffn
7441
7442 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7443 Opens an image file.
7444 @end deffn
7445
7446 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7447 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7448 @end deffn
7449
7450 @deffn Command {etm start}
7451 Starts trace data collection.
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7455 Stops trace data collection.
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7459 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7460
7461 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7462
7463 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7464 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7465 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7466 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7467 any trace data collection.}
7468 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7469 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7470 @end deffn
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7474 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7475 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7476 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7477 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7478 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7479 @end deffn
7480 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7481 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7482 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7483 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7484 trace trigger becomes active.
7485
7486 @itemize
7487 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7488 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7489 afterwards.
7490 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7491 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7492 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7493 what caused that event to happen.
7494 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7495 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7496 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7497 how the event caused trouble.
7498 @end itemize
7499 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7500 @end deffn
7501
7502 @end deffn
7503
7504 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7505 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7506 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7507 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7508 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7509
7510 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7511 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7512
7513 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7514 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7515 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7516 @end deffn
7517
7518 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7519 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7520 @end deffn
7521
7522 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7523 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7524 @end deffn
7525 @end deffn
7526
7527
7528 @section Generic ARM
7529 @cindex ARM
7530
7531 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7532 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7533 commands that may be available.
7534
7535 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7536 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7537 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7538 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7539 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7540 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7541 @end deffn
7542
7543 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7544 @cindex disassemble
7545 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7546 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7547 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7548 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7549 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7550 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7551 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7552
7553 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7554 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7555 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7556 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7557 with a handful of exceptions.
7558 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7559 @end deffn
7560
7561 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7562 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7563 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7564 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7565 and using the MCR instruction.
7566 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7567 an ARM register.)
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7571 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7572 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7573 and the MRC instruction.
7574 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7575 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7576 an ARM register.)
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7580 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7581 core mode if necessary.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7585 @cindex ARM semihosting
7586 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7587
7588 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7589 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7590 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7591 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7592 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7593 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7597 @cindex ARM semihosting
7598 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
7599 status.
7600
7601 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
7602 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
7603 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
7604 debugger.
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7608 @cindex ARMv4
7609 @cindex ARMv5
7610
7611 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7612 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7613 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7614 variant.
7615
7616 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7617 @cindex ARM7
7618 @cindex ARM9
7619
7620 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7621 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7622 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7623 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7624
7625 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7626 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7627 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7628 instead of breakpoints.
7629 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7630
7631 This should be
7632 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7633 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7634 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7638 @cindex DCC
7639 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7640 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7641 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7642
7643 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7644 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7645 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7649 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7650 that don't check completion of the operation.
7651 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7652
7653 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7654 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7655 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7656 @end deffn
7657
7658 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7659 @cindex ARM720T
7660
7661 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7662 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7663 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7664 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7665
7666 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7667 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7668 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7669
7670 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7671 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7672 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7676 @cindex ARM9
7677
7678 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7679 integer processors.
7680 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7681
7682 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7683 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7684 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7685 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7686
7687 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7688 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7689 @cindex vector_catch
7690 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7691 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7692 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7693 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7694 to those hardware vectors.
7695
7696 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7697 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7698 vector catch hardware to intercept
7699 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7700 @option{none} of them,
7701 or a list with one or more of the following:
7702 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7703 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7707 @cindex ARM920T
7708
7709 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7710 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7711 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7712 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7713 and ARM9 commands.
7714
7715 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7716 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7717 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7721 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7722 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7723 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7724 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7725 (Not all registers can be written.)
7726 @end deffn
7727
7728 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7729 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7730 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7731
7732 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7733 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7734 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7735 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7736 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7737 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7738 @end deffn
7739
7740 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7741 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7742 @end deffn
7743
7744 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7745 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7749 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7750
7751 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7752 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7753 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7754 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7755 and ARM9 commands.
7756
7757 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7758 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7759
7760 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7761 Print information about the caches found.
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7765 @cindex ARM966E
7766
7767 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7768 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7769 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7770 and ARM9 commands.
7771
7772 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7773 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7774 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7775 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7776 ARM966E-S TRM.
7777 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7778 as required for BIST support.
7779 @end deffn
7780
7781 @subsection XScale specific commands
7782 @cindex XScale
7783
7784 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7785
7786 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7787 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7788 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7789 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7790 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7791 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7792 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7793
7794 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7795 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7796 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7797 the mini-IC.
7798
7799 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7800 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7801 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7802 code layout in memory:
7803 @example
7804 _vectors:
7805 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7806 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7807 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7808 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7809 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7810 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7811 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7812 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7813 .org 0x100
7814 .long real_reset_vector
7815 .long real_ui_handler
7816 .long real_swi_handler
7817 .long real_pf_abort
7818 .long real_data_abort
7819 .long 0 /* unused */
7820 .long real_irq_handler
7821 .long real_fiq_handler
7822 @end example
7823
7824 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7825 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7826 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7827 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7828 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7829 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7830 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7831 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7832 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7833 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7834 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7835 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7836 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7837 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7838 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7839 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7840 software.
7841
7842 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7843 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7844 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7845 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7846
7847 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7848 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7849 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7850 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7851 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7852 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7853 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7854 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7855 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7856
7857 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7858 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7859
7860 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7861 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7862 @end deffn
7863
7864 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7865 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7866 @end deffn
7867
7868 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7869 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7870 @end deffn
7871
7872 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7873 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7874 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7875 @end deffn
7876
7877 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7878 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7879 @end deffn
7880
7881 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7882 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7883 @end deffn
7884
7885 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7886 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7890 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7891 @end deffn
7892
7893 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7894 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7895 @end deffn
7896
7897 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7898 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7899 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7900 and modifying how it is emptied.
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7904 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7905 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7906 The image @var{type} may be one of
7907 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7908 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7909 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7913 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7914 @cindex vector_catch
7915 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7916 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7917
7918 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7919 @example
7920 0x01 Trap Reset
7921 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7922 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7923 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7924 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7925 0x20 reserved
7926 0x40 Trap IRQ
7927 0x80 Trap FIQ
7928 @end example
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7932 @cindex vector_table
7933
7934 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7935 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7936 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7937 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7938 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7939
7940 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7941
7942 @end deffn
7943
7944 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7945 @cindex ARMv6
7946
7947 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7948 @cindex ARM11
7949
7950 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7951 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7952 which is enabled by default.
7953 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7954 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7955 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7956 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7957 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7958 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7959 @end deffn
7960
7961 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7962 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7963 which is enabled by default.
7964 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7965 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7966 @end deffn
7967
7968 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7969 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7970 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7971 they are disabled by default.
7972 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7973 @end deffn
7974
7975 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7976 @cindex vector_catch
7977 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7978 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7979 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7980
7981 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7982 for certain hardware events.
7983 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7984 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7985 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7986 @end deffn
7987
7988 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
7989 @cindex ARMv7
7990 @cindex ARMv8
7991
7992 @subsection ARMv7 and ARMv8 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7993 @cindex Debug Access Port
7994 @cindex DAP
7995 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 and v8 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7996 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7997 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7998
7999 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
8000 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
8001 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
8002 @end deffn
8003
8004 @deffn Command {dap apreg} ap_num reg [value]
8005 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
8006 or set a new value @var{value}.
8007 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
8008 @end deffn
8009
8010 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
8011 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
8012 @end deffn
8013
8014 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
8015 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
8016 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
8017 @end deffn
8018
8019 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
8020 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
8021 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
8022 @end deffn
8023
8024 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
8025 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
8026 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
8027 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8028 @end deffn
8029
8030 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
8031 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
8032 Defaulting to 0.
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
8036 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
8037 Disabled by default
8038 @end deffn
8039
8040
8041 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8042 @cindex Cortex-A
8043
8044 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8045 display information about target caches
8046 @end deffn
8047
8048 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8049 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8050 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8051 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8052 Defaults to 'off'.
8053 @end deffn
8054
8055 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8056 Initialize core debug
8057 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8061 Disable SMP mode
8062 @end deffn
8063
8064 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8065 Enable SMP mode
8066 @end deffn
8067
8068 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8069 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8070 @end deffn
8071
8072 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8073 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8077 configure l2x cache
8078 @end deffn
8079
8080
8081 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8082 @cindex Cortex-R
8083
8084 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8085 Initialize core debug
8086 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8087 @end deffn
8088
8089 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8090 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8091 @end deffn
8092
8093
8094 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8095 @cindex tracing
8096 @cindex SWO
8097 @cindex SWV
8098 @cindex TPIU
8099 @cindex ITM
8100 @cindex ETM
8101
8102 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8103 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8104 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8105
8106 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8107 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8108 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8109 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8110
8111 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8112 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8113 debugger adapter features.
8114
8115 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8116 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8117
8118 Command options:
8119 @itemize @minus
8120 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8121 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8122 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8123 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8124 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8125 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8126 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8127 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8128 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8129 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8130 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8131 coding;
8132 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8133 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8134 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8135 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8136 data is to be output via SWO;
8137 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8138 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8139 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8140 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8141 rate automatically.
8142 @end itemize
8143
8144 Example usage:
8145 @enumerate
8146 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8147 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8148 enough to:
8149 @example
8150 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8151 ...
8152 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8153 ...
8154 @end example
8155 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8156 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8157 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8158 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8159 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8160 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8161 @example
8162 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8163 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8164 @end example
8165 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8166 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8167 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8168 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8169 @example
8170 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8171 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8172 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8173 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8174 @end example
8175 @end enumerate
8176 @end deffn
8177
8178 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8179 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8180 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8184 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8188 @cindex Cortex-M
8189
8190 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8191 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8192
8193 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8194 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8195 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8196 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8197 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8198 the step command leaves with the core running.
8199
8200 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8201 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8202 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8203
8204 Default is @option{auto}.
8205 @end deffn
8206
8207 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8208 @cindex vector_catch
8209 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8210 for certain hardware events.
8211
8212 Parameters request interception of
8213 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8214 @option{none} of them,
8215 or one or more of the following:
8216 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8217 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8218 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8219 @option{irq_err},
8220 @option{state_err},
8221 @option{chk_err}, or
8222 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8223 @option{reset}.
8224 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8225 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8226 are mapped to HardFault.
8227 UsageFault checks for
8228 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8229 must also be explicitly enabled.
8230
8231 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8232 @end deffn
8233
8234 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8235 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8236 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8237 @itemize @minus
8238 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8239 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8240 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8241 @end itemize
8242 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8243 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8244 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8245 the peripherals.
8246 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8247 @end deffn
8248
8249 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
8250 @cindex ARMv8-A
8251 @cindex aarch64
8252
8253 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
8254 Display information about target caches
8255 @end deffn
8256
8257 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
8258 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
8259 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
8260 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
8261 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
8262 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
8263 @end deffn
8264
8265 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
8266 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
8267 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
8268 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
8269 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
8270 @end deffn
8271
8272 @section Intel Architecture
8273
8274 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8275 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8276 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8277 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8278 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8279 @itemize
8280 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8281 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8282 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8283 @end itemize
8284
8285 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8286 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8287 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8288
8289 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8290 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8291 @end deffn
8292
8293 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8294 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8295 @end deffn
8296
8297 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8298 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8299 @end deffn
8300
8301 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8302 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8306 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8307 @end deffn
8308
8309 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8310 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8314
8315 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8316 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8317
8318 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8319 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8320 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8321 @end deffn
8322 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8323 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8324
8325 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8326
8327 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8328 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8329 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8330 @end deffn
8331
8332 @subsection Registers commands
8333 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8334 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8335 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8336
8337 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8338
8339 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8340 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8341 and "timer" groups.
8342
8343 @emph{example:}
8344 @example
8345 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8346 @end example
8347
8348
8349 @end deffn
8350 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8351 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8352
8353 @emph{group} can be "system",
8354 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8355 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8356 @end deffn
8357
8358 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8359 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8360 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8361 @cindex tracing
8362 @cindex libdcc
8363 @cindex DCC
8364 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8365 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8366 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8367 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8368
8369 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8370 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8371 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8372 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8373 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8374 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8375
8376 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8377 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8378 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8379 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8380 The target being debugged may
8381 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8382 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8383 each supported by a command:
8384
8385 @itemize
8386 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8387 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8388 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8389 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8390
8391 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8392 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8393 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8394
8395 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8396 and then displayed at any time.
8397 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8398
8399 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8400 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8401 @end itemize
8402
8403 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8404 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8405 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8406 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8407 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8408 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8409 does the same thing.
8410
8411 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8412 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8413 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8414 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8415 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8416
8417 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8418 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8419 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8420 @end deffn
8421
8422 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8423 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8424 in the order they triggered.
8425 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8426 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8427 history records.
8428 @end deffn
8429
8430 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8431 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8432 they have been triggered.
8433 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8434 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8435 and associates it with that identifier.
8436
8437 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8438 are not related except by this command.
8439 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8440 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8441 @end deffn
8442
8443
8444 @node JTAG Commands
8445 @chapter JTAG Commands
8446 @cindex JTAG Commands
8447 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8448 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8449 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8450 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8451 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8452
8453 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8454 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8455
8456 @itemize @bullet
8457 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8458 devices such as a CPUs.
8459 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8460 standard state machine (in parallel)
8461 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8462 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8463 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8464 while the reading previous ones.
8465 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8466 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8467 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8468 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8469 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8470 registers.
8471 @end itemize
8472
8473 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8474
8475 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8476 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8477 the order of TAP state transitions.
8478 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8479 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8480 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8481 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8482 these commands are not available.
8483
8484 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8485 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8486 that specify the entire register.
8487 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8488 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8489 The return value holds the original value of each
8490 of those fields.
8491
8492 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8493 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8494 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8495 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8496 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8497
8498 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8499 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8500
8501 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8502 in that state.
8503 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8504 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8505 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8506
8507 @quotation Warning
8508 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8509 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8510 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8511 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8512 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8513 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8514 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8515 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8516 @end quotation
8517 @end deffn
8518
8519 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8520 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8521 This may be used for performance tuning.
8522
8523 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8524 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8525 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8526 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8527 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8528 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8532 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8533 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8534 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8535 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8536 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8537
8538 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8539 in that state.
8540 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8541 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8542 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8543
8544 @quotation Note
8545 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8546 register values, unlike data register values.
8547 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8548 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8549 @end quotation
8550 @end deffn
8551
8552 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8553 Set values of reset signals.
8554 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8555 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8556 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8557 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8558 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8559 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8560 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8561
8562 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8563 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8564 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8565 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8566 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8567 instead of the TRST signal.
8568 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8569 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8570 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8571 with handlers for that event.
8572 @end deffn
8573
8574 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8575 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8576 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8577 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8578 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8579 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8580 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8581 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8582 The final state must also be stable.
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8586 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8587 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8588 Instructions often need some time
8589 to execute before they take effect.
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8593 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8594
8595 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8596 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8597 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8598 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8599 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8600 @end deffn
8601
8602 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8603 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8604 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8605 must also be enabled.
8606 Default is enabled.
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @section TAP state names
8610 @cindex TAP state names
8611
8612 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8613 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8614 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8615 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8616
8617 @itemize @bullet
8618 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8619 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8620 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8621 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8622 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8623 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8624 through the data register
8625 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8626 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8627 for update or more shifting
8628 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8629 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8630 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8631 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8632 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8633 through the instruction register
8634 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8635 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8636 for update or more shifting
8637 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8638 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8639 @end itemize
8640
8641 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8642 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8643 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8644 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8645
8646 @itemize @bullet
8647 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8648 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8649 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8650 may not be as expected.
8651 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8652 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8653 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8654 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8655 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8656 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8657 @end itemize
8658
8659 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8660 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8661
8662 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8663 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8664 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8665 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8666
8667 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8668 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8669 @cindex SVF
8670
8671 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8672 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8673 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8674 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8675
8676 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8677 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8678 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8679 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8680 each command is logged before it is executed.
8681 @end deffn
8682
8683 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8684 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8685 @cindex XSVF
8686
8687 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8688 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8689 Xilinx devices.
8690 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8691 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8692
8693 @quotation Important
8694 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8695 @end quotation
8696
8697 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8698 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8699 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8700 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8701 that TAP.
8702 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8703 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8704 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8705 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8706 @end deffn
8707
8708 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8709 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8710 after building the software.
8711 You may find them useful:
8712
8713 @itemize
8714 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8715 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8716 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8717 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8718 @end itemize
8719
8720 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8721 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8722 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8723 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8724 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8725 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8726 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8727
8728
8729 @node Utility Commands
8730 @chapter Utility Commands
8731 @cindex Utility Commands
8732
8733 @section RAM testing
8734 @cindex RAM testing
8735
8736 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8737 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8738 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8739 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8740 hardware problems.
8741
8742 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8743 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8744 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8745 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8746
8747 Load the memory testing functions with
8748
8749 @example
8750 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8751 @end example
8752
8753 to get access to the following facilities:
8754
8755 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8756 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8757 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8758 @end deffn
8759
8760 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8761 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8762 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8763 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8764 @end deffn
8765
8766 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8767 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8768 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8769 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8770 @end deffn
8771
8772 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8773 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8774 @end deffn
8775
8776 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8777 @cindex Firmware recovery
8778
8779 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8780 devices recovery with JTAG.
8781
8782 For quickstart instructions run:
8783 @example
8784 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8785 @end example
8786
8787 @node TFTP
8788 @chapter TFTP
8789 @cindex TFTP
8790 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8791 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8792
8793 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8794 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8795 server (tftpd). For example,
8796
8797 @example
8798 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8799 @end example
8800
8801 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8802 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8803
8804 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8805 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8806 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8807 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8808
8809 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8810 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8811 @cindex GDB
8812 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8813 to debug remote targets.
8814 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8815
8816 @itemize
8817 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8818 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8819 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8820 as shown in this chapter.
8821 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8822 that also will probably need to be configured.
8823 @end itemize
8824
8825 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8826 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8827 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8828 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8829 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8830 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8831
8832 @section Connecting to GDB
8833 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8834 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8835 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8836 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8837 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8838
8839 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8840
8841 @enumerate
8842 @item
8843 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8844 @example
8845 target remote localhost:3333
8846 @end example
8847 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8848
8849 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8850 @example
8851 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8852 @end example
8853 @item
8854 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8855 @example
8856 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8857 @end example
8858 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8859 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8860 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8861 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8862 @end enumerate
8863
8864 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8865 GDB command line.
8866
8867 @section Sample GDB session startup
8868
8869 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8870 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8871 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8872 small ARM program.
8873 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8874 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8875
8876 @example
8877 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8878 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8879 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8880 ...
8881 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8882 ...
8883 (gdb) load
8884 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8885 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8886 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8887 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8888 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8889 (gdb) continue
8890 Continuing.
8891 ...
8892 @end example
8893
8894 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8895 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8896 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8897 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8898
8899 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8900
8901 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8902 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8903 packet size and the device's memory map.
8904 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8905 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8906 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8907
8908 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8909 You may need to set those up by hand.
8910 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8911 something like:
8912
8913 @example
8914 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8915 @end example
8916
8917 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8918
8919 @example
8920 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8921 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8922 @end example
8923
8924 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8925 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8926 do not have such restrictions.
8927
8928 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8929 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8930 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8931
8932 @example
8933 define hook-step
8934 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8935 end
8936 define hookpost-step
8937 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8938 end
8939 @end example
8940
8941 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8942 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8943 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8944 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8945
8946 @section Programming using GDB
8947 @cindex Programming using GDB
8948 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8949
8950 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8951 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8952 @example
8953 gdb_memory_map disable
8954 @end example
8955 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8956 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8957 working area.
8958
8959 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8960 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8961 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8962 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8963
8964 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8965 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8966
8967 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8968 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8969 @example
8970 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8971 @end example
8972
8973 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8974 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8975
8976 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8977 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8978 will be used.
8979
8980 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8981 script can be executed:
8982 @example
8983 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8984 @end example
8985
8986 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8987 can be used.
8988 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8989 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8990 @cindex SMP
8991 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8992 @itemize @bullet
8993 @item j - smp status request
8994 @item J - smp set request
8995 @end itemize
8996
8997 OpenOCD implements :
8998 @itemize @bullet
8999 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
9000 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
9001 @option{E01} for target not smp.
9002 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
9003 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
9004 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
9005 @end itemize
9006
9007 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
9008 @itemize @bullet
9009 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
9010 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
9011 @example
9012 set $_core 1
9013 #Jc01 packet is sent
9014 print $_core
9015 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
9016 @end example
9017
9018 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
9019 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
9020
9021 @example
9022 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
9023 define toggle0
9024 maint packet Jc0
9025 continue
9026 main packet Jc-1
9027 end
9028 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
9029 define toggle1
9030 maint packet Jc1
9031 continue
9032 main packet Jc-1
9033 end
9034 @end example
9035 @end itemize
9036
9037 @section RTOS Support
9038 @cindex RTOS Support
9039 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
9040
9041 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
9042 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
9043
9044 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
9045 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
9046 GDB commands.
9047
9048 @* An example setup is below:
9049
9050 @example
9051 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
9052 @end example
9053
9054 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
9055
9056 Currently supported rtos's include:
9057 @itemize @bullet
9058 @item @option{eCos}
9059 @item @option{ThreadX}
9060 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
9061 @item @option{linux}
9062 @item @option{ChibiOS}
9063 @item @option{embKernel}
9064 @item @option{mqx}
9065 @item @option{uCOS-III}
9066 @end itemize
9067
9068 @quotation Note
9069 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
9070 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
9071 @end quotation
9072
9073 @table @code
9074 @item eCos symbols
9075 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
9076 @item ThreadX symbols
9077 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
9078 @item FreeRTOS symbols
9079 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
9080 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
9081 @tex
9082 \begingroup
9083 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
9084 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
9085 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
9086 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
9087 \par
9088 \endgroup
9089 @end tex
9090 @item linux symbols
9091 init_task.
9092 @item ChibiOS symbols
9093 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
9094 @item embKernel symbols
9095 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
9096 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
9097 @item mqx symbols
9098 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
9099 @item uC/OS-III symbols
9100 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
9101 @end table
9102
9103 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
9104 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
9105
9106 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
9107 along with the project:
9108
9109 @table @code
9110 @item FreeRTOS
9111 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
9112 @item uC/OS-III
9113 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
9114 @end table
9115
9116 @node Tcl Scripting API
9117 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
9118 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
9119 @cindex Tcl scripts
9120 @section API rules
9121
9122 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
9123 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
9124 of state information as an argument to each proc.
9125
9126 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
9127 pair list and lists.
9128
9129 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
9130 list.
9131
9132 @example
9133 > set foo(me) Duane
9134 > set foo(you) Oyvind
9135 > set foo(mouse) Micky
9136 > set foo(duck) Donald
9137 @end example
9138
9139 If one does this:
9140
9141 @example
9142 > set foo
9143 @end example
9144
9145 The result is:
9146
9147 @example
9148 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
9149 @end example
9150
9151 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
9152
9153 @verbatim
9154 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
9155 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
9156 }
9157 @end verbatim
9158
9159 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
9160 should be passed in to the proc in question.
9161
9162 @section Internal low-level Commands
9163
9164 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
9165 invoke directly.
9166
9167 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
9168 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
9169 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
9170
9171 @itemize @bullet
9172 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9173
9174 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
9175 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9176
9177 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
9178 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
9179
9180 Return information about the flash banks
9181
9182 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
9183
9184 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9185 its execution. Example:
9186
9187 @example
9188 > capture "reset init"
9189 @end example
9190
9191 @end itemize
9192
9193 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9194 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9195 called "flash_banks".
9196
9197 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9198
9199 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9200 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9201 holds one of the following values:
9202
9203 @itemize @bullet
9204 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9205 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9206 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9207 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9208 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9209 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9210 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9211 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9212 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9213 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9214 @end itemize
9215
9216 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9217
9218 @quotation Note
9219 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9220 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9221 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9222 is jim, not real tcl).
9223 @end quotation
9224
9225 @section Tcl RPC server
9226 @cindex RPC
9227
9228 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9229 commands and receive the results.
9230
9231 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9232 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9233 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9234 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9235 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9236
9237 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9238 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9239 @command{capture} command.
9240
9241 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9242
9243 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9244 @cindex RPC Notifications
9245
9246 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9247 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9248
9249 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9250 in the following format.
9251
9252 @verbatim
9253 type target_event event [event-name]
9254 type target_state state [state-name]
9255 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9256 @end verbatim
9257
9258 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9259 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9260 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9261 Defaults to off.
9262
9263 @end deffn
9264
9265 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9266 @cindex RPC trace output
9267
9268 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9269 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9270
9271 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9272
9273 @verbatim
9274 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9275 @end verbatim
9276
9277 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9278 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9279 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9280 Defaults to off.
9281
9282 See an example application here:
9283 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9284
9285 @end deffn
9286
9287 @node FAQ
9288 @chapter FAQ
9289 @cindex faq
9290 @enumerate
9291 @anchor{faqrtck}
9292 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9293 @cindex RTCK
9294 @cindex adaptive clocking
9295 @*
9296
9297 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9298 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9299 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9300 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9301
9302 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9303 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9304 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9305 @enumerate
9306 @item
9307 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9308 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9309 @item
9310 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9311 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9312 @end enumerate
9313
9314 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9315 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9316 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9317 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9318 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9319 power).
9320
9321 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9322 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9323 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9324 ARM926 scenario).
9325 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9326 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9327 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9328
9329 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9330 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9331 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9332 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9333
9334 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9335
9336 In order to make use of this,
9337 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9338 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9339
9340 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9341 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9342 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9343 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9344 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9345
9346 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9347 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9348 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9349 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9350
9351 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9352 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9353 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9354 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9355 with a CPLD.
9356 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9357 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9358 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9359 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9360 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9361 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9362
9363 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9364
9365 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9366
9367 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9368 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9369 depending on the chips on your board.
9370 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9371 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9372 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9373
9374 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9375 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9376 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9377
9378 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9379 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9380 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9381 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9382
9383 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9384 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9385 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9386 this way.
9387
9388 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9389 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9390 clock rate.
9391 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9392 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9393 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9394
9395 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9396
9397 @example
9398 # Example: 1.234MHz
9399 adapter_khz 1234
9400 @end example
9401
9402
9403 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9404
9405 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9406 around Windows filenames.
9407
9408 @example
9409 > echo \a
9410
9411 > echo @{\a@}
9412 \a
9413 > echo "\a"
9414
9415 >
9416 @end example
9417
9418
9419 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9420
9421 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9422 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9423 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9424
9425 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9426 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9427 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9428
9429 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9430 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9431 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9432
9433 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9434
9435 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9436 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9437 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9438 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9439
9440 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9441 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9442 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9443
9444 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9445 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9446
9447 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9448 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9449 memory read caused data abort".
9450
9451 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9452 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9453 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9454 be done, feel free to add this here.
9455
9456 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9457 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9458 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9459 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9460 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9461 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9462 gracefully stops.
9463
9464 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9465 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9466 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9467
9468 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9469 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9470 bytes. Painful...
9471
9472
9473 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9474 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9475
9476 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9477 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9478 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9479 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9480 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9481 reset, everything else should work fine.
9482
9483 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9484 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9485 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9486 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9487
9488 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9489 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9490 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9491 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9492
9493 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9494
9495 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9496 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9497 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9498
9499 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9500 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9501
9502 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9503 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9504 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9505 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9506 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9507 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9508 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9509 clock frequency?
9510
9511 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9512 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9513 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9514 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9515 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9516
9517 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9518
9519 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9520 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9521 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9522 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9523 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9524 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9525 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9526
9527 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9528
9529 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9530 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9531 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9532 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9533
9534 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9535 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9536 particular order?
9537
9538 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9539 the same order used by the hardware.
9540
9541 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9542 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9543 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9544 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9545 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9546 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9547
9548 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9549 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9550 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9551 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9552
9553 @itemize @bullet
9554 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9555 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9556 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9557 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9558 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9559 @end itemize
9560
9561 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9562
9563 @itemize @bullet
9564 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9565 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9566 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9567 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9568 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9569 @end itemize
9570
9571
9572 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9573 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9574 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9575
9576 TODO.
9577
9578 @end enumerate
9579
9580 @node Tcl Crash Course
9581 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9582 @cindex Tcl
9583
9584 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9585 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9586 how the Tcl scripts work.
9587
9588 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9589 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9590 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9591 OpenOCD.
9592
9593 @section Tcl Rule #1
9594 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9595 @enumerate
9596 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9597 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9598 @end enumerate
9599
9600 The Tcl equal is this:
9601
9602 @enumerate
9603 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9604 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9605 @end enumerate
9606
9607 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9608 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9609
9610 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9611 There is a second pair of rules.
9612 @enumerate
9613 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9614 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9615 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9616 in Tcl.
9617 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9618 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9619 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9620 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9621 @end enumerate
9622
9623 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9624 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9625 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9626 Everything is a string}
9627
9628 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9629 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9630 difference is subtle.
9631 @enumerate
9632 @item Parse Time
9633 @item Evaluation Time
9634 @end enumerate
9635
9636 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9637 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9638 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9639
9640 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9641 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9642 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9643 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9644
9645 @itemize @bullet
9646 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9647 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9648 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9649 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9650 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9651 @example
9652 # bash example
9653 X=`date`
9654 echo "The Date is: $X"
9655 # Tcl example
9656 set X [date]
9657 puts "The Date is: $X"
9658 @end example
9659 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9660 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9661 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9662 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9663 is a string}
9664 @example
9665 set x "Dinner"
9666 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9667 @end example
9668 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9669 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9670 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9671 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9672 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9673 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9674 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9675 @end itemize
9676
9677 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9678
9679 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9680
9681 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9682
9683 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9684 the normal way.
9685
9686 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9687 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9688 line is immedatly executed.
9689
9690 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9691 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9692
9693 @subsection Command Execution
9694
9695 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9696 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9697 control flow operators.
9698
9699 Commands are executed like this:
9700
9701 @enumerate
9702 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9703 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9704 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9705 @end enumerate
9706
9707 It sort of works like this:
9708 @example
9709 for(;;)@{
9710 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9711
9712 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9713
9714 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9715 @}
9716 @end example
9717
9718 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9719 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9720 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9721 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9722 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9723 ``LookupCommand()''
9724
9725 @subsection The FOR command
9726
9727 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9728 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9729 command just like any other command.
9730
9731 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9732 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9733 are:
9734
9735 @enumerate 0
9736 @item The ascii text 'for'
9737 @item The start text
9738 @item The test expression
9739 @item The next text
9740 @item The body text
9741 @end enumerate
9742
9743 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9744 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9745 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9746 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9747
9748 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9749 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9750
9751 @example
9752 int
9753 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9754 int *argc,
9755 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9756 @end example
9757
9758 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9759 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9760 still operates in the same basic way.
9761
9762 @subsection FOR command implementation
9763
9764 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9765 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9766
9767 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9768
9769 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9770
9771 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9772 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9773 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9774
9775 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9776 expression and returns a value.
9777
9778 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9779 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9780 @example
9781 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9782
9783 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9784
9785 int
9786 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9787 int argc,
9788 char **argv )
9789 @{
9790 if( argc != 5 )@{
9791 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9792 return ERROR;
9793 @}
9794
9795 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9796
9797 // Execute the start statement.
9798 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9799
9800 // Top of loop test
9801 for(;;)@{
9802 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9803 if( i == 0 )
9804 break;
9805
9806 // Execute the body
9807 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9808
9809 // Execute the LOOP part
9810 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9811 @}
9812
9813 // Return no error
9814 SetResult( interp, "" );
9815 return SUCCESS;
9816 @}
9817 @end example
9818
9819 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9820 in the same basic way.
9821
9822 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9823
9824 @subsection source and find commands
9825 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9826 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9827 @*Remember the parsing rules
9828 @enumerate
9829 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9830 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9831 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9832 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9833 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9834 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9835 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9836 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9837 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9838 @end enumerate
9839 @subsection format command
9840 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9841 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9842 @b{sprintf()}.
9843 @b{Example}
9844 @example
9845 set x 6
9846 set y 7
9847 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9848 @end example
9849 @enumerate
9850 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9851 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9852 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9853 @* Refer to Rule #1
9854 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9855 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9856 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9857 @end enumerate
9858 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9859 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9860 @example
9861 #1 Good
9862 proc someproc @{@} @{
9863 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9864 @}
9865 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9866 #2 Good - no variables
9867 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9868 #3 Good Curly Braces
9869 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9870 puts "Time: [date]"
9871 @}
9872 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9873 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9874 @end example
9875 @enumerate
9876 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9877 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9878 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9879 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9880 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9881 command.
9882 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9883 @*There are 4 examples:
9884 @enumerate
9885 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9886 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9887 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9888 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9889 @end enumerate
9890
9891 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9892 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9893 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9894
9895 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9896 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9897 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9898 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9899 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9900 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9901 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9902 @end enumerate
9903 @subsection Global Variables
9904 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9905 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9906 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9907 @example
9908 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9909 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9910 global x #Global variable X
9911 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9912 @}
9913 @end example
9914 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9915 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9916 @example
9917 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9918 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9919 # Create var name
9920 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9921 # Make it a global
9922 global $vn
9923 # Set it.
9924 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9925 @}
9926 @end example
9927 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9928 @example
9929 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9930 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9931 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9932 @}
9933 @end example
9934
9935 @include fdl.texi
9936
9937 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9938 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9939 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9940 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9941 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9942 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9943
9944 @printindex cp
9945
9946 @node Command and Driver Index
9947 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9948 @printindex fn
9949
9950 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)